blob: 8207067a2ca5046b8812e00c490d55ae8019cabc [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8860dcd2014-04-26 00:08:14 +02007 2014/04/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
498 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100499 - tune.zlib.memlevel
500 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100501
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200502 * Debugging
503 - debug
504 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505
506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005073.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508------------------------------------
509
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200510ca-base <dir>
511 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200512 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
513 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200514
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515chroot <jail dir>
516 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
517 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
518 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
519 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
520 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
521 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100522
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100523cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
524 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
525 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
526 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
527 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
528 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
529 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
530 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
531 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
532 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
533 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
534 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
535 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
536 they overlap.
537
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200538crt-base <dir>
539 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
540 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
541 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
542
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200543daemon
544 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
545 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
546 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
547
548gid <number>
549 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
550 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
551 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100552 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
553 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200554 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556group <group name>
557 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
558 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100559
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200560log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200561 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
562 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100563 configured with "log global".
564
565 <address> can be one of:
566
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100567 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100568 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
569 port).
570
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100571 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
572 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
573 port).
574
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100575 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
576 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
577 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
578 writeable).
579
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100580 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
581 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
582 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
583 in Bourne shell.
584
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100585 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586
587 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
588 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
589 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
590
591 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200592 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
593 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
594 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
595 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
596 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
597 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200599 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100601log-send-hostname [<string>]
602 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
603 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
604 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
605 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
606 the logs.
607
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000608log-tag <string>
609 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
610 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
611 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
612 running on the same host.
613
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614nbproc <number>
615 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
616 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
617 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
618 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
619 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
620
621pidfile <pidfile>
622 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
623 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
624 starting the process. See also "daemon".
625
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100626stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200627 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
628 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
629 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
630 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
631 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
632 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
633 the number of processes used.
634
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100635ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
636 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
637 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300638 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100639 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
640 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
641 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
642 "bind" keyword for more information.
643
644ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
645 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
646 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300647 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100648 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
649 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
650 information.
651
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100652ssl-server-verify [none|required]
653 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
654 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
655 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
656
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200657stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
658 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
659 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
660 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
661 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200662
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200663 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
664 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
665 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200666
667stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
668 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
669 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100670 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200671
672stats maxconn <connections>
673 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
674 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
675
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200676uid <number>
677 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
678 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
679 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
680 one. See also "gid" and "user".
681
682ulimit-n <number>
683 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
684 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
685 option.
686
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100687unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
688 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
689
690 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
691 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
692 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
693 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
694 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
695 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
696 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
697 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
698 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
699 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
700
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200701user <user name>
702 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
703 See also "uid" and "group".
704
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200705node <name>
706 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
707
708 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
709 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
710 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
711 traffic.
712
713description <text>
714 Add a text that describes the instance.
715
716 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
717 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
718 "<" and ">" characters.
719
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007213.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200722-----------------------
723
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200724max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
725 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
726 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
727 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
728 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
729 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
730 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
731 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
732 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200734maxconn <number>
735 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
736 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
737 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
738 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
739
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200740maxconnrate <number>
741 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
742 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
743 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
744 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
745 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
746 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
747 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
748 fairness.
749
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100750maxcomprate <number>
751 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300752 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100753 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
754 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
755 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
756 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
757 default value.
758
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100759maxcompcpuusage <number>
760 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
761 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
762 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
763 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
764 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
765 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
766 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
767 process down and from introducing high latencies.
768
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100769maxpipes <number>
770 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
771 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
772 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
773 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
774 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
775 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
776
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200777maxsessrate <number>
778 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
779 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
780 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
781 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
782 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
783 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
784 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
785 fairness.
786
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200787maxsslconn <number>
788 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
789 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
790 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
791 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
792 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
793 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
794 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
795
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200796maxsslrate <number>
797 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
798 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
799 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
800 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
801 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
802 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
803 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
804 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
805 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
806 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
807
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100808maxzlibmem <number>
809 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
810 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
811 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100812 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
813 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
814 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
815
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200816noepoll
817 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
818 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100819 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820
821nokqueue
822 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
823 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
824 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
825
826nopoll
827 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
828 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100829 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100830 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200831
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100832nosplice
833 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
834 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
835 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100836 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100837 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
838 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
839 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
840 "option splice-response".
841
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300842nogetaddrinfo
843 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
844 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
845
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200846spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900847 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
848 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
849 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
850 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
851 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
852 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200853
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200854tune.bufsize <number>
855 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
856 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
857 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
858 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
859 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
860 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
861 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
862 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400863 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
864 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
865 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200866
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200867tune.chksize <number>
868 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
869 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
870 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
871 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
872 checks whenever possible.
873
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100874tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
875 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
876 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
877 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
878 this value. The default value is 1.
879
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100880tune.http.cookielen <number>
881 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
882 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
883 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
884 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
885 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
886 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
887 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
888 to change this value.
889
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200890tune.http.maxhdr <number>
891 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
892 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
893 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
894 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
895 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
896 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
897 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
898 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
899 limit too high.
900
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100901tune.idletimer <timeout>
902 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
903 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
904 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
905 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
906 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
907 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
908 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
909 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
910 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
911
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100912tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100913 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
914 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
915 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
916 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
917 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
918 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
919 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
920 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
921 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
922 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100923
924tune.maxpollevents <number>
925 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
926 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
927 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
928 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
929 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
930
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200931tune.maxrewrite <number>
932 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
933 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
934 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
935 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
936 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
937 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
938 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
939 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
940 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
941 bufsize.
942
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200943tune.pipesize <number>
944 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
945 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
946 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
947 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
948 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
949 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
950
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100951tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
952tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
953 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
954 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
955 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
956 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
957 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
958 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
959 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
960
961tune.sndbuf.client <number>
962tune.sndbuf.server <number>
963 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
964 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
965 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
966 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
967 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
968 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
969 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
970 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
971 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
972 notifying haproxy again.
973
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100974tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100975 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
976 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
977 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300978 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100979 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
980 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
981 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
982 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
983 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100984 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
985 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100986
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100987tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
988 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300989 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100990 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
991 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
992 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
993 being used for too long.
994
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100995tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
996 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
997 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
998 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
999 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1000 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1001 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1002 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1003 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1004 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1005 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001006 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1007 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001008
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001009tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1010 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001011 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001012 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1013 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1014 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1015
1016tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1017 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1018 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1019 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1020 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001021
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010223.3. Debugging
1023--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001024
1025debug
1026 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1027 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1028 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1029 system startup.
1030
1031quiet
1032 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1033 line argument "-q".
1034
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001035
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010363.4. Userlists
1037--------------
1038It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1039http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1040it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1041
1042userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001043 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001044 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1045
1046group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001047 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001048 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1049 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1050
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001051user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1052 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001053 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1054 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001055 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1056 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001057 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001058 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001059
1060
1061 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001062 userlist L1
1063 group G1 users tiger,scott
1064 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001065
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001066 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1067 user scott insecure-password elgato
1068 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001069
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001070 userlist L2
1071 group G1
1072 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001073
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001074 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1075 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1076 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001077
1078 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001079
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001080
10813.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001082----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001083It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1084haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1085pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1086identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1087or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1088Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1089known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1090the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1091process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1092during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1093tables.
1094
1095peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001096 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001097 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1098
1099peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1100 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1101 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1102 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1103 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1104 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1105 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1106
1107 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1108 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1109
1110 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1111 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1112 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1113 across all peers.
1114
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001115 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1116 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1117 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1118
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001119 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001120 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001121 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1122 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1123 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001124
1125 backend mybackend
1126 mode tcp
1127 balance roundrobin
1128 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1129 stick on src
1130
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001131 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1132 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001133
1134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011354. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001137
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001138Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1139 - defaults <name>
1140 - frontend <name>
1141 - backend <name>
1142 - listen <name>
1143
1144A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1145its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1146section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001147section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001148
1149A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1150connections.
1151
1152A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1153to forward incoming connections.
1154
1155A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1156parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1157
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001158All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1159'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1160case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1161
1162Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1163logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1164proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1165However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1166name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1167
1168Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1169and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001170bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001171protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1172modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1173arbitrary criteria.
1174
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001175In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1176a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1177the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1178
1179 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1180 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1181 between responses and new requests.
1182
1183 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1184 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1185 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1186 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1187
1188 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1189 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1190 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1191
1192 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1193 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1194 client-facing connection remains open.
1195
1196 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1197 after the end of the response.
1198
1199The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1200frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1201following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1202weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1203
1204 Backend mode
1205
1206 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1207 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1208 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1209 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1210 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1211 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1212 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1213 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1214 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1215 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1216 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1217
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001218
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001219
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012204.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1221--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001223The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1224limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1225they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1226limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001227marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001228option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001229and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1230with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1231specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001232
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001233
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001234 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1235------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1236acl - X X X
1237appsession - - X X
1238backlog X X X -
1239balance X - X X
1240bind - X X -
1241bind-process X X X X
1242block - X X X
1243capture cookie - X X -
1244capture request header - X X -
1245capture response header - X X -
1246clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001247compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001248contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1249cookie X - X X
1250default-server X - X X
1251default_backend X X X -
1252description - X X X
1253disabled X X X X
1254dispatch - - X X
1255enabled X X X X
1256errorfile X X X X
1257errorloc X X X X
1258errorloc302 X X X X
1259-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1260errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001261force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001262fullconn X - X X
1263grace X X X X
1264hash-type X - X X
1265http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001266http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001267http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001268http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001269http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001270http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001271id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001272ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001273log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001274max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001275maxconn X X X -
1276mode X X X X
1277monitor fail - X X -
1278monitor-net X X X -
1279monitor-uri X X X -
1280option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1281option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1282option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1283option allbackups (*) X - X X
1284option checkcache (*) X - X X
1285option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1286option contstats (*) X X X -
1287option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1288option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1289option forceclose (*) X X X X
1290-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1291option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001292option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001293option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001294option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001295option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001296option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001297option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1298option httpchk X - X X
1299option httpclose (*) X X X X
1300option httplog X X X X
1301option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001302option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001303option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001304option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1305option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1306option logasap (*) X X X -
1307option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001308option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001309option nolinger (*) X X X X
1310option originalto X X X X
1311option persist (*) X - X X
1312option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001313option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001314option smtpchk X - X X
1315option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1316option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1317option splice-request (*) X X X X
1318option splice-response (*) X X X X
1319option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1320option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1321-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001322option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001323option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1324option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1325option tcpka X X X X
1326option tcplog X X X X
1327option transparent (*) X - X X
1328persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1329rate-limit sessions X X X -
1330redirect - X X X
1331redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1332redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1333reqadd - X X X
1334reqallow - X X X
1335reqdel - X X X
1336reqdeny - X X X
1337reqiallow - X X X
1338reqidel - X X X
1339reqideny - X X X
1340reqipass - X X X
1341reqirep - X X X
1342reqisetbe - X X X
1343reqitarpit - X X X
1344reqpass - X X X
1345reqrep - X X X
1346-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1347reqsetbe - X X X
1348reqtarpit - X X X
1349retries X - X X
1350rspadd - X X X
1351rspdel - X X X
1352rspdeny - X X X
1353rspidel - X X X
1354rspideny - X X X
1355rspirep - X X X
1356rsprep - X X X
1357server - - X X
1358source X - X X
1359srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001360stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001361stats auth X - X X
1362stats enable X - X X
1363stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001364stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001365stats realm X - X X
1366stats refresh X - X X
1367stats scope X - X X
1368stats show-desc X - X X
1369stats show-legends X - X X
1370stats show-node X - X X
1371stats uri X - X X
1372-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1373stick match - - X X
1374stick on - - X X
1375stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001376stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001377stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001378tcp-check connect - - X X
1379tcp-check expect - - X X
1380tcp-check send - - X X
1381tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001382tcp-request connection - X X -
1383tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001384tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001385tcp-response content - - X X
1386tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001387timeout check X - X X
1388timeout client X X X -
1389timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1390timeout connect X - X X
1391timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1392timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1393timeout http-request X X X X
1394timeout queue X - X X
1395timeout server X - X X
1396timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1397timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001398timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001399transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001400unique-id-format X X X -
1401unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001402use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001403use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001404------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1405 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001406
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001407
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014084.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1409---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001410
1411This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1412
1413
1414acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1415 Declare or complete an access list.
1416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1417 no | yes | yes | yes
1418 Example:
1419 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1420 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1421 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001423 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001424
1425
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001426appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1427 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001428 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1430 no | no | yes | yes
1431 Arguments :
1432 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1433 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1434
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001435 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001436 checked in each cookie value.
1437
1438 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1439 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1440 milliseconds.
1441
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001442 request-learn
1443 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1444 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1445 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1446 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1447 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1448 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1449
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001450 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1451 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1452 data following this prefix.
1453
1454 Example :
1455 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1456
1457 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1458 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1459
1460 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1461 2 modes are currently supported :
1462 - path-parameters :
1463 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1464 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1465 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1466 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1467 - query-string :
1468 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1469 query string.
1470
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001471 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1472 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1473 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1474 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001475 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1476 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1477 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001478 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1479 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1480
1481 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1482
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001483 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1484 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1485 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1486
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001487 Example :
1488 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1489
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001490 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1491 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001492
1493
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001494backlog <conns>
1495 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1497 yes | yes | yes | no
1498 Arguments :
1499 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1500 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001501 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001502
1503 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1504 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1505 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1506 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1507 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1508 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1509 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1510 backlog parameter.
1511
1512 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1513 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1514 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1515
1516 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1517
1518
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001519balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001520balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001521 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1523 yes | no | yes | yes
1524 Arguments :
1525 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1526 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1527 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1528 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1529
1530 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1531 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1532 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1533 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001534 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001535 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001536 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1537 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1538 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1539 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1540 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1541 it, so that you don't worry.
1542
1543 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1544 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1545 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1546 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1547 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1548 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1549 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1550 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001551
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001552 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1553 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1554 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1555 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1556 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1557 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1558 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1559 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1560
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001561 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001562 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001563 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1564 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001565 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001566 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1567 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1568 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1569 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1570 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001571 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1572 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1573 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1574 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1575 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1576 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001577
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001578 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1579 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1580 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1581 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1582 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1583 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1584 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1585 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001586 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001587 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001588 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1589 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1590 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001591
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001592 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1593 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1594 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1595 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1596 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1597 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1598 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1599 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1600 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1601 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1602 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1603 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001604
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001605 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001606 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1607 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1608 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1609 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1610 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1611 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1612 URIs start with a leading "/".
1613
1614 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1615 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1616 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1617 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1618
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001619 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001620 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1621
1622 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001623 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1624 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001625 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1626 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1627 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1628 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001629 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001630 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1631 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001632
1633 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1634 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1635 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1636 server will receive the request.
1637
1638 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1639 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1640 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1641 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1642 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001643 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1644 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1645 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001646
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001647 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1648 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1649 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1650 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1651 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001652
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001653 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001654 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1655 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1656 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1657
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001658 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1659 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1660 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1661
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001662 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001663 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001664 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1665 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1666 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1667 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1668 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1669 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001670 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001671 used instead.
1672
1673 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1674 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1675 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1676 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1677
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001678 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1679 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1680 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1681
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001682 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001683
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001684 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001685 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1686 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001687
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001688 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1689 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1690 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001691
1692 Examples :
1693 balance roundrobin
1694 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001695 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001696 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1697 balance hdr(host)
1698 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001699
1700 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1701 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1702
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001703 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001704 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1705 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1706 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1707 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1708
1709 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1710 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1711 defaults to 16 kB.
1712
1713 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1714 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1715
1716 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1717 Round Robin.
1718
1719 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1720 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1721 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1722 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1723
1724 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1725
1726 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001727 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001728 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1729 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1730 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001731
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001732 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1733 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001734
1735
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001736bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1737bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001738 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1740 no | yes | yes | no
1741 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001742 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1743 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1744 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1745 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001746 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001747 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1748 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1749 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1750 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1751 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1752 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1753 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001754 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1755 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1756 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001757 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1758 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1759 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1760 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001761
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001762 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1763 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001764 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1765 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1766 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001767 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1768 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1769 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1770 the range.
1771
1772 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1773 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1774 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1775 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1776 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1777 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1778 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001779 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001780 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001781
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001782 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1783 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1784 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1785 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1786 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1787 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1788 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1789 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1790
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001791 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1792 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1793 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1794 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001795
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001796 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1797 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1798 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1799 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1800 in a frontend.
1801
1802 Example :
1803 listen http_proxy
1804 bind :80,:443
1805 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001806 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001807
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001808 listen http_https_proxy
1809 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001810 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001811
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001812 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1813 bind ipv6@:80
1814 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1815 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1816
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001817 listen external_bind_app1
1818 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1819
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001820 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001821 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001822
1823
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001824bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001825 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1827 yes | yes | yes | yes
1828 Arguments :
1829 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1830 may be used to override a default value.
1831
1832 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1833 option may be combined with other numbers.
1834
1835 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1836 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1837 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1838 missing from all processes.
1839
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001840 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1841 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1842 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1843 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1844 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001845
1846 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1847 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1848 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1849 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1850 and 'even' instances.
1851
1852 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1853 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1854 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1855 32.
1856
1857 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1858 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1859
1860 Example :
1861 listen app_ip1
1862 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001863 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001864
1865 listen app_ip2
1866 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001867 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001868
1869 listen management
1870 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001871 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001872
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001873 listen management
1874 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1875 bind-process 1-4
1876
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001877 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1878
1879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001880block { if | unless } <condition>
1881 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1883 no | yes | yes | yes
1884
1885 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1886 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001887 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001888 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001889 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1890 "block" statements per instance.
1891
1892 Example:
1893 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1894 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1895 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1896 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1897
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001898 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001899
1900
1901capture cookie <name> len <length>
1902 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1904 no | yes | yes | no
1905 Arguments :
1906 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1907 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1908 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1909 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1910 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1911
1912 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1913 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1914 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1915 right if it exceeds <length>.
1916
1917 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1918 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1919 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1920 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1921
1922 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1923 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1924 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1925
1926 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1927 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1928 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001929 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1930 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1931 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001932
1933 Example:
1934 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1935
1936 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001937 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001938
1939
1940capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001941 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1943 no | yes | yes | no
1944 Arguments :
1945 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001946 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001947 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1948 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1949 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1950
1951 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1952 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1953 it exceeds <length>.
1954
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001955 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001956 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1957 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001958 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1959 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1960 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1961 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001962 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001963 environments to find where the request came from.
1964
1965 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1966 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1967 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1968 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001969
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001970 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1971 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1972 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1973 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1974 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001975
1976 Example:
1977 capture request header Host len 15
1978 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1979 capture request header Referrer len 15
1980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001981 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001982 about logging.
1983
1984
1985capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001986 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1988 no | yes | yes | no
1989 Arguments :
1990 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001991 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001992 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1993 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1994 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1995
1996 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1997 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1998 it exceeds <length>.
1999
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002000 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002001 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2002 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2003 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002004 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2005 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2006 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2007 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002008
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002009 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2010 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2011 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2012 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2013 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002014
2015 Example:
2016 capture response header Content-length len 9
2017 capture response header Location len 15
2018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002019 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020 about logging.
2021
2022
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002023clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002024 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2026 yes | yes | yes | no
2027 Arguments :
2028 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2029 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2030 as explained at the top of this document.
2031
2032 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2033 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2034 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2035 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2036 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2037 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2038 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2039 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002040 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002041 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2042 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2043
2044 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2045 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2046 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2047 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2048 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2049 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2050
2051 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2052 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2053
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002054 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2055 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002056
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002057compression algo <algorithm> ...
2058compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002059compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002060 Enable HTTP compression.
2061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2062 yes | yes | yes | yes
2063 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002064 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2065 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2066 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2067
2068 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002069 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002070 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2071 data.
2072
2073 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2074 support for zlib was built in.
2075
2076 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2077 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2078 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2079 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2080 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2081 in.
2082
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002083 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002084 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002085 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2086 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2087 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2088 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2089 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002090
2091 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2092 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2093 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2094 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2095 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002096 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2097 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2098 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2099 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2100 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2101 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002102
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002103 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002104 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2105 "Accept-Encoding" header
2106 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002107 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002108 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2109 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002110 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2111 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2112 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2113 "multipart"
2114 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2115 header
2116 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2117 and later
2118 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2119 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002120
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002121 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2122 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002123
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002124 Examples :
2125 compression algo gzip
2126 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002127
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002128contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002129 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2131 yes | no | yes | yes
2132 Arguments :
2133 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2134 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2135 as explained at the top of this document.
2136
2137 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002138 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002139 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002140 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2141 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2142 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2143 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2144
2145 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2146 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2147 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2148 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2149 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2150 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2151
2152 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2153 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2154 instead.
2155
2156 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2157 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2158
2159
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002160cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002161 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2162 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002163 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2165 yes | no | yes | yes
2166 Arguments :
2167 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2168 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2169 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2170 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2171 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2172 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2173 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2174 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2175 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2176
2177 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2178 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2179 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2180 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2181 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2182 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2183 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2184 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2185 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2186 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2187 "insert" and "prefix".
2188
2189 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002190 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002191
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002192 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002193 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2194 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2195 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2196 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2197 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2198 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2199 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2200 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2201 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2202 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002203
2204 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2205 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2206 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2207 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2208 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2209 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2210 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2211 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2212 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2213 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002214 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2215 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2216 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002217
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002218 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2219 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2220 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002221 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2222 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2223 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2224 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002225 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2226 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2227 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002228
2229 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2230 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2231 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2232 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2233 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2234 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2235 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2236 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2237 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2238
2239 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2240 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2241 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2242 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2243 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2244 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2245 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2246 persistence cookie in the cache.
2247 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2248
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002249 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2250 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2251 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2252 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2253 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2254 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2255 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2256 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2257 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2258 they logout.
2259
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002260 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2261 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2262 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2263 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2264
2265 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2266 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2267 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2268 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2269 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2270 this attribute.
2271
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002272 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002273 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002274 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2275 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2276 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2277 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2278 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2279 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002280
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002281 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2282 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2283 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2284 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2285 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2286 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2287 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2288 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2289 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2290 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2291 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2292 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2293 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2294 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2295 the site.
2296
2297 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2298 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2299 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2300 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2301 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2302 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2303 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2304 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2305 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2306 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2307 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2308 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2309 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2310 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2311 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2312 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2313
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002314 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2315 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2316 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2317 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002318
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002319 Examples :
2320 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2321 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2322 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002323 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002324
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002325 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002326 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002327
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002328
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002329default-server [param*]
2330 Change default options for a server in a backend
2331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2332 yes | no | yes | yes
2333 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002334 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2335 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2336 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2337 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002338
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002339 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002340 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2341
2342 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002343
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002344
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002345default_backend <backend>
2346 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2348 yes | yes | yes | no
2349 Arguments :
2350 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2351
2352 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2353 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2354 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2355 will catch all undetermined requests.
2356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002357 Example :
2358
2359 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2360 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2361 default_backend dynamic
2362
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002363 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2364
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002365
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002366description <string>
2367 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2369 no | yes | yes | yes
2370 Arguments : string
2371
2372 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2373 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2374 it describes.
2375 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2376
2377
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002378disabled
2379 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2381 yes | yes | yes | yes
2382 Arguments : none
2383
2384 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2385 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2386 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2387 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2388 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2389 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2390 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2391
2392 See also : "enabled"
2393
2394
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002395dispatch <address>:<port>
2396 Set a default server address
2397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2398 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002399 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002400
2401 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2402 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2403 during start-up.
2404
2405 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2406 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2407 possible with normal servers.
2408
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002409 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002410 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2411 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2412 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2413 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2414
2415 See also : "server"
2416
2417
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002418enabled
2419 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2421 yes | yes | yes | yes
2422 Arguments : none
2423
2424 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2425 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2426
2427 See also : "disabled"
2428
2429
2430errorfile <code> <file>
2431 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2433 yes | yes | yes | yes
2434 Arguments :
2435 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002436 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002437
2438 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002439 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002440 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002441 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2442 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002443
2444 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2445 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2446 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2447
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002448 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2449
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002450 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2451 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2452 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2453 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2454
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002455 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2456 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2457 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2458 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2459 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2460 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2461
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002462 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2463 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2464 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002465 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002466 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2467
2468 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2469
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002470 Example :
2471 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2472 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2473 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2474
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002475
2476errorloc <code> <url>
2477errorloc302 <code> <url>
2478 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2480 yes | yes | yes | yes
2481 Arguments :
2482 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002483 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002484
2485 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2486 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2487 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2488 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2489 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2490
2491 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2492 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2493 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2494
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002495 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2496
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002497 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2498 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2499 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2500 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2501 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2502 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2503 request.
2504
2505 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2506
2507
2508errorloc303 <code> <url>
2509 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2511 yes | yes | yes | yes
2512 Arguments :
2513 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2514 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2515
2516 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2517 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2518 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2519 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2520 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2521
2522 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2523 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2524 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2525
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002526 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2527
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002528 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2529 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2530 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2531 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002532 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002533
2534 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2535
2536
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002537force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2538 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2539 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2540 no | yes | yes | yes
2541
2542 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2543 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2544 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2545 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2546 marked down for maintenance operations.
2547
2548 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2549 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2550 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2551 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2552 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2553 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2554 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2555 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2556 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2557
2558 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2559 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2560 is used.
2561
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002562 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002563 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002564
2565
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002566fullconn <conns>
2567 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2569 yes | no | yes | yes
2570 Arguments :
2571 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2572 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2573
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002574 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002575 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002576 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002577 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2578 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2579 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2580 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2581 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002582 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002583
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002584 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2585 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002586 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2587 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2588 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002589
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002590 Example :
2591 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2592 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2593 # connections.
2594 backend dynamic
2595 fullconn 10000
2596 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2597 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2598
2599 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2600
2601
2602grace <time>
2603 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002605 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002606 Arguments :
2607 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2608 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2609 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2610
2611 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2612 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002613 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002614 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2615
2616 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2617 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2618 simplify it.
2619
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002620
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002621hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002622 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2624 yes | no | yes | yes
2625 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002626 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2627 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002628
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002629 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2630 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2631 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2632 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2633 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2634 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2635 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2636 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2637 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2638 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002639
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002640 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2641 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2642 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2643 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2644 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2645 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2646 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2647 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2648 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2649 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2650 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2651 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2652 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002653 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2654 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002655
2656 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2657
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002658 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002659 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2660 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2661 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002662 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2663 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2664 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002665
2666 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2667 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002668 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2669 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2670 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2671 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2672
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002673 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2674 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2675 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2676 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2677 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2678 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2679 parameter.
2680
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002681 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2682
2683 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2684 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2685 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2686 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2687 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2688 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2689 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2690 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2691 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2692 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2693 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2694 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002695
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002696 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2697 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2698 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002699
2700 See also : "balance", "server"
2701
2702
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002703http-check disable-on-404
2704 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002706 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002707 Arguments : none
2708
2709 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2710 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2711 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2712 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2713 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2714 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2715 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2716 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002717 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2718 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2719 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2720
2721 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2722
2723
2724http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002725 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002727 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002728 Arguments :
2729 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2730 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002731 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002732 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2733 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2734 details on the supported keywords.
2735
2736 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2737 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2738 with the usual backslash ('\').
2739
2740 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2741 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2742 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2743 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2744 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2745
2746 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002747 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002748 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2749 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2750 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2751
2752 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002753 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002754 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2755 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2756 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2757 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2758
2759 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002760 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002761 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2762 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2763 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2764 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2765 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2766 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2767 trace).
2768
2769 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002770 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002771 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2772 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2773 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2774 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2775 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2776 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2777
2778 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2779 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2780 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2781 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2782 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2783 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2784 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2785 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2786
2787 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2788 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2789
2790 Examples :
2791 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002792 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002793
2794 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002795 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002796
2797 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002798 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002799
2800 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002801 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002802
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002803 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002804
2805
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002806http-check send-state
2807 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2809 yes | no | yes | yes
2810 Arguments : none
2811
2812 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2813 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2814 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2815 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2816 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2817
2818 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2819 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2820 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2821 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2822 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2823 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2824 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2825 checked in multiple backends.
2826
2827 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2828 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2829
2830 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2831 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2832 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2833 one fails.
2834
2835 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2836 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2837 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2838
2839 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2840 server's queue.
2841
2842 Example of a header received by the application server :
2843 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2844 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2845
2846 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2847
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002848http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002849 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002850 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002851 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2852 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2853 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2854 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2855 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2856 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002857 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002858 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2859
2860 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2861 no | yes | yes | yes
2862
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002863 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2864 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2865 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2866 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2867 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002868
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002869 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2870 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2871 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2872
2873 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2874 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2875 are evaluated.
2876
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002877 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2878 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2879 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2880 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2881 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2882 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2883 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2884 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2885 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002886 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002887 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2888
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002889 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2890 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2891 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2892 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2893 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2894
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002895 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2896 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2897 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002898 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2899 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002900
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002901 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2902 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2903 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2904 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2905 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2906 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2907 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2908 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2909
2910 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2911 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2912 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2913 external users.
2914
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002915 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2916 <name>.
2917
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002918 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2919 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2920 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2921 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2922 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2923 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2924 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2925 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2926
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002927 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2928 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2929 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2930 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2931 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2932 another equipment.
2933
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002934 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2935 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2936 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2937 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2938 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2939 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2940 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2941 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2942
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002943 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2944 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2945 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2946 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2947 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2948 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2949 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2950 admin privileges.
2951
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002952 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
2953 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
2954 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2955 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
2956 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
2957 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
2958 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
2959 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2960
2961 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
2962 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
2963 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2964 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
2965 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
2966 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2967
2968 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
2969 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
2970 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2971 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
2972 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
2973 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2974
2975 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
2976 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
2977 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
2978 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
2979 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
2980 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
2981 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
2982 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
2983 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2984
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002985 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2986
2987 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2988 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2989 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2990 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002991
2992 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002993 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2994 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2995 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002996
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002997 http-request allow if nagios
2998 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2999 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3000 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003001
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003002 Example:
3003 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003004 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003005
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003006 Example:
3007 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3008 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3009 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3010 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3011 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3012 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3013 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3014 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3015 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3016
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003017 Example:
3018 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3019 acl add path /addacl
3020 acl del path /delacl
3021
3022 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3023
3024 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3025 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3026
3027 Example:
3028 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3029 acl setmap path /setmap
3030 acl delmap path /delmap
3031
3032 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3033
3034 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3035 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3036
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003037 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3038 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003039
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003040http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003041 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003042 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3043 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3044 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3045 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3046 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3047 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003048 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003049 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3050
3051 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3052 no | yes | yes | yes
3053
3054 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3055 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3056 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3057 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3058 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3059 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3060
3061 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3062 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3063 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3064 current section.
3065
3066 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3067 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3068 rules are evaluated.
3069
3070 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3071 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3072 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3073 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3074 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3075 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3076 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3077
3078 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3079 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3080 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3081 external users.
3082
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003083 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3084 <name>.
3085
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003086 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3087 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3088 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3089 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3090 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3091 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3092 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3093 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3094
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003095 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3096 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3097 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3098 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3099 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3100 another equipment.
3101
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003102 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3103 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3104 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3105 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3106 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3107 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3108 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3109 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3110
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003111 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3112 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3113 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3114 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3115 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3116 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3117 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3118 admin privileges.
3119
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003120 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3121 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3122 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3123 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3124 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3125 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3126 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3127 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3128
3129 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3130 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3131 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3132 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3133 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3134 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3135
3136 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3137 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3138 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3139 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3140 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3141 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3142
3143 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3144 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3145 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3146 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3147 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3148 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3149 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3150 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3151 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3152
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003153 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3154
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003155 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003156 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3157 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3158 rules.
3159
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003160 Example:
3161 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3162
3163 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3164
3165 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3166 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3167
3168 Example:
3169 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3170
3171 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3172
3173 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3174 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3175
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003176 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3177 ACL usage.
3178
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003179
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003180http-send-name-header [<header>]
3181 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3182
3183 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3184 yes | no | yes | yes
3185
3186 Arguments :
3187
3188 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3189
3190 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3191 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3192 is added with the header string proved.
3193
3194 See also : "server"
3195
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003196id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003197 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3199 no | yes | yes | yes
3200 Arguments : none
3201
3202 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3203 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3204 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003205
3206
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003207ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3208 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3209 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3210 no | yes | yes | yes
3211
3212 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3213 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3214 and running).
3215
3216 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3217 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3218 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003219 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003220 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3221
3222 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3223 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3224
3225 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3226 "unless" condition is met.
3227
3228 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3229
3230
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003231log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003232log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003233no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003234 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3236 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003237
3238 Prefix :
3239 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3240 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3241 prefix does not allow arguments.
3242
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003243 Arguments :
3244 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3245 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3246 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3247 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3248 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3249 parameter.
3250
3251 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3252 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3253
3254 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3255 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3256 standard syslog port).
3257
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003258 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3259 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3260 standard syslog port).
3261
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003262 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3263 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3264 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3265 appropriately writeable).
3266
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003267 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3268 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3269 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3270 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3271
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003272 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3273
3274 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3275 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3276 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3277
3278 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3279 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3280 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003281 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3282 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3283 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3284 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3285 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003286
3287 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3288
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003289 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3290 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3291 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003292
3293 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3294 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3295 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3296 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3297
3298 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3299 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003300
3301 Example :
3302 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003303 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3304 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003305 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3306
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003307
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003308log-format <string>
3309 Allows you to custom a log line.
3310
3311 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3312
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003313
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003314max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3315 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3316 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3317 yes | no | yes | yes
3318
3319 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3320 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3321 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3322 servers.
3323
3324 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3325 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3326 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3327 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3328 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3329 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3330 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3331 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3332 picking a different server.
3333
3334 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3335 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3336 even if they have to be queued.
3337
3338 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3339 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3340
3341
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003342maxconn <conns>
3343 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3345 yes | yes | yes | no
3346 Arguments :
3347 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3348 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3349 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3350 closes.
3351
3352 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3353 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3354 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3355 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3356 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3357 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3358 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3359 properly tuned.
3360
3361 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3362 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3363 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3364
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003365 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3366
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003367 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3368
3369
3370mode { tcp|http|health }
3371 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3373 yes | yes | yes | yes
3374 Arguments :
3375 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3376 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3377 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3378 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3379
3380 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3381 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3382 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3383 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3384 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3385
3386 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003387 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3388 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3389 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3390 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3391 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3392 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3393 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003394
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003395 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3396 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3397 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003398
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003399 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003400 defaults http_instances
3401 mode http
3402
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003403 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003404
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003405
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003406monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003407 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3409 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003410 Arguments :
3411 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3412 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003413 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003414 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3415 backend and its backup.
3416
3417 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3418 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3419 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3420 servers in a list of backends.
3421
3422 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3423 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3424 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3425 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3426 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3427 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3428 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003429 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3430 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003431
3432 Example:
3433 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003434 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003435 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3436 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3437 monitor-uri /site_alive
3438 monitor fail if site_dead
3439
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003440 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003441
3442
3443monitor-net <source>
3444 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3446 yes | yes | yes | no
3447 Arguments :
3448 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3449 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3450 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3451 followed by a mask.
3452
3453 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3454 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003455 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003456 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3457
3458 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3459 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3460 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3461 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003462 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3463 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3464 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003465
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003466 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3467 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3468 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3469 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3470 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3471 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003472
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003473 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3474 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003475
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003476 Example :
3477 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3478 frontend www
3479 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3480
3481 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3482
3483
3484monitor-uri <uri>
3485 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3487 yes | yes | yes | no
3488 Arguments :
3489 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3490 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3491
3492 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3493 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3494 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3495 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3496 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3497 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3498 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3499 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3500
3501 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3502 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3503 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3504 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3505 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3506 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3507
3508 Example :
3509 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3510 frontend www
3511 mode http
3512 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3513
3514 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3515
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003516
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003517option abortonclose
3518no option abortonclose
3519 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3521 yes | no | yes | yes
3522 Arguments : none
3523
3524 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3525 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3526 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3527 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003528 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003529 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3530 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3531 encountered while delivering the response.
3532
3533 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3534 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3535 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3536 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3537 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3538 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003539 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003540 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003541 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003542 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3543 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3544 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3545
3546 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3547 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3548 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3549 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3550 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3551 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3552 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3553 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003554 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003555
3556 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3557 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3558
3559 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3560
3561
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003562option accept-invalid-http-request
3563no option accept-invalid-http-request
3564 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3566 yes | yes | yes | no
3567 Arguments : none
3568
3569 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3570 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3571 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3572 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3573 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3574 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3575 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3576 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003577 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3578 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3579 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3580 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3581 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3582 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003583
3584 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3585 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3586 been confirmed.
3587
3588 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3589 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003590 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3591 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003592 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3593
3594 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3595 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3596
3597 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3598 stats socket.
3599
3600
3601option accept-invalid-http-response
3602no option accept-invalid-http-response
3603 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3605 yes | no | yes | yes
3606 Arguments : none
3607
3608 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3609 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3610 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3611 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3612 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3613 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3614 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3615 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3616 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3617
3618 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3619 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3620 been confirmed.
3621
3622 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3623 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3624 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3625 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3626
3627 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3628 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3629
3630 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3631 stats socket.
3632
3633
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003634option allbackups
3635no option allbackups
3636 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3638 yes | no | yes | yes
3639 Arguments : none
3640
3641 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3642 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3643 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3644 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3645 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3646 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3647 order between the backup servers anymore.
3648
3649 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3650 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3651
3652 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3653 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3654
3655
3656option checkcache
3657no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003658 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3660 yes | no | yes | yes
3661 Arguments : none
3662
3663 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3664 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003665 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003666 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3667 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003668 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003669
3670 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003671 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003672 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003673 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3674 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003675 to the client are :
3676 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003677 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003678 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003679 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3680 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3681 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3682 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3683 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3684 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3685 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3686 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3687 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3688 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3689 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3690
3691 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003692 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003693 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003694 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003695 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3696
3697 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3698 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003699 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003700 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3701
3702 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3703 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3704
3705
3706option clitcpka
3707no option clitcpka
3708 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3710 yes | yes | yes | no
3711 Arguments : none
3712
3713 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3714 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3715 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3716 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3717
3718 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3719 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3720 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3721 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3722
3723 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3724 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3725 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3726 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3727 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3728
3729 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3730
3731 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3732 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3733 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3734
3735 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3736 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3737
3738 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3739
3740
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003741option contstats
3742 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3744 yes | yes | yes | no
3745 Arguments : none
3746
3747 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3748 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3749 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3750 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3751 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3752 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3753 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3754
3755
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003756option dontlog-normal
3757no option dontlog-normal
3758 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3760 yes | yes | yes | no
3761 Arguments : none
3762
3763 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3764 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3765 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3766 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3767 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3768 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3769 logged.
3770
3771 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3772 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3773 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3774
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003775 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003776 logging.
3777
3778
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003779option dontlognull
3780no option dontlognull
3781 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3783 yes | yes | yes | no
3784 Arguments : none
3785
3786 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3787 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3788 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3789 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3790 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3791 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3792 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3793
3794 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3795 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3796 would not be logged.
3797
3798 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3799 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003801 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003802
3803
3804option forceclose
3805no option forceclose
3806 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003808 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003809 Arguments : none
3810
3811 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3812 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3813 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3814 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3815 global session times in the logs.
3816
3817 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003818 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003819 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003820
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003821 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3822 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3823 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3824
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003825 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3826 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003827
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003828 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3829 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3830
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003831 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003832
3833
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003834option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003835 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3837 yes | yes | yes | yes
3838 Arguments :
3839 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3840 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003841 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003842 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003843
3844 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3845 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3846 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3847 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3848 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3849 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3850 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003851 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3852 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3853 possible that the client has already brought one.
3854
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003855 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003856 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003857 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3858 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003859 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3860 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003861
3862 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3863 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3864 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3865 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3866 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3867 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3868 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3869
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003870 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3871 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3872 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3873 are under the control of the end-user.
3874
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003875 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003876 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3877 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003878 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3879 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3880 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003881
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003882 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003883 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3884 frontend www
3885 mode http
3886 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3887
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003888 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3889 backend www
3890 mode http
3891 option forwardfor header X-Client
3892
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003893 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003894 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003895
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003896
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003897option http-keep-alive
3898no option http-keep-alive
3899 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3901 yes | yes | yes | yes
3902 Arguments : none
3903
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003904 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
3905 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
3906 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
3907 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
3908 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
3909 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
3910 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
3911
3912 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
3913 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003914 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3915 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3916 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3917 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3918 situations where this option may be useful :
3919
3920 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3921 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3922
3923 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3924 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3925
3926 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3927 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3928 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3929 request.
3930
3931 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3932 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003933 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3934 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3935 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003936
3937 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3938 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3939
3940 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3941 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3942 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3943 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3944 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3945 not set.
3946
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003947 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3948 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003949 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003950 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003951
3952 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003953 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3954 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003955
3956
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003957option http-no-delay
3958no option http-no-delay
3959 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3961 yes | yes | yes | yes
3962 Arguments : none
3963
3964 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3965 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3966 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3967 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3968 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3969 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3970 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3971 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3972 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3973 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3974 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3975 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3976 affected.
3977
3978 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3979 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3980 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3981 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3982 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3983 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3984 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3985 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3986 latency environments.
3987
3988
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003989option http-pretend-keepalive
3990no option http-pretend-keepalive
3991 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3993 yes | yes | yes | yes
3994 Arguments : none
3995
3996 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3997 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3998 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3999 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4000 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4001 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4002 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4003 consider the response complete.
4004
4005 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4006 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4007 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4008 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4009 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4010 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4011
4012 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4013 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4014 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4015 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4016 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4017 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4018 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4019
4020 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4021 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004022 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004023 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4024 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004025
4026 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4027 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4028
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004029 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4030 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004031
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004032
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004033option http-server-close
4034no option http-server-close
4035 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4037 yes | yes | yes | yes
4038 Arguments : none
4039
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004040 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4041 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4042 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4043 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4044 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4045 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4046 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4047 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4048 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4049 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4050 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4051 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4052 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4053 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4054 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4055 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004056
4057 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4058 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4059 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4060 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004061 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4062 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004063
4064 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4065 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004066 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4067 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004068 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4069 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004070
4071 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4072 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4073
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004074 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004075 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4076 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004077
4078
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004079option http-tunnel
4080no option http-tunnel
4081 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4083 yes | yes | yes | yes
4084 Arguments : none
4085
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004086 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4087 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4088 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4089 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4090 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4091 "option http-tunnel".
4092
4093 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004094 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004095 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4096 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4097 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4098 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4099 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4100 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4101 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004102
4103 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4104 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4105
4106 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4107 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4108 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4109
4110
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004111option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004112no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004113 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4115 yes | yes | yes | no
4116 Arguments : none
4117
4118 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4119 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4120 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4121 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4122 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4123 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4124 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4125
4126 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4127 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4128 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4129 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4130 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4131 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4132 request along its whole life.
4133
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004134 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4135 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4136 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4137 front of an existing proxy.
4138
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004139 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4140
4141 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4142 http-server-close".
4143
4144
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004145option httpchk
4146option httpchk <uri>
4147option httpchk <method> <uri>
4148option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4149 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4151 yes | no | yes | yes
4152 Arguments :
4153 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4154 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4155 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4156 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4157 ones.
4158
4159 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4160 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4161 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4162
4163 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4164 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4165 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4166 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4167 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4168
4169 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4170 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4171 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4172 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4173 the lack of any response.
4174
4175 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4176
4177 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4178 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4179 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4180
4181 Examples :
4182 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4183 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4184 backend https_relay
4185 mode tcp
4186 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4187 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4188
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004189 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4190 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4191 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004192
4193
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004194option httpclose
4195no option httpclose
4196 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4198 yes | yes | yes | yes
4199 Arguments : none
4200
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004201 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4202 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4203 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4204 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004205 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004206 "option http-tunnel".
4207
4208 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4209 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4210 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4211 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4212 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4213 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4214 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4215 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004216
4217 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004218 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004219 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4220 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4221 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4222 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4223 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004224
4225 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4226 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004227 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4228 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004229 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4230 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004231
4232 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4233 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4234
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004235 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4236 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004237
4238
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004239option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004240 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4242 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004243 Arguments :
4244 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4245 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4246 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4247 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4248 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004249
4250 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4251 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4252 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4253 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4254 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4255 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4256 ports.
4257
4258 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4259
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004260 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4261 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4262 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4263 by default.
4264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004265 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004266
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004267
4268option http_proxy
4269no option http_proxy
4270 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4272 yes | yes | yes | yes
4273 Arguments : none
4274
4275 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4276 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4277 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4278 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4279 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4280
4281 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4282 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4283 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4284 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004285 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004286 be analyzed.
4287
4288 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4289 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4290
4291 Example :
4292 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4293 backend direct_forward
4294 option httpclose
4295 option http_proxy
4296
4297 See also : "option httpclose"
4298
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004299
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004300option independent-streams
4301no option independent-streams
4302 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4304 yes | yes | yes | yes
4305 Arguments : none
4306
4307 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4308 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4309 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4310 receive data or not.
4311
4312 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4313 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4314 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4315 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4316 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4317 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4318 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4319 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4320 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4321 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4322 socket buffers.
4323
4324 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4325 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4326 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4327 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4328 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4329
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004330 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004331 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4332 deprecated.
4333
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004334 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004335
4336
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004337option ldap-check
4338 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4340 yes | no | yes | yes
4341 Arguments : none
4342
4343 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4344 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4345 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4346 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4347
4348 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4349 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4350
4351 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4352 configure it.
4353
4354 Example :
4355 option ldap-check
4356
4357 See also : "option httpchk"
4358
4359
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004360option log-health-checks
4361no option log-health-checks
4362 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4364 yes | no | yes | yes
4365 Arguments : none
4366
4367 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4368 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4369 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4370 of additional information is limited.
4371
4372 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4373 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4374
4375 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4376
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004377
4378option log-separate-errors
4379no option log-separate-errors
4380 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4382 yes | yes | yes | no
4383 Arguments : none
4384
4385 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4386 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4387 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4388 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4389 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4390 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4391 provides very important information.
4392
4393 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4394 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4395 error logs.
4396
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004397 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004398 logging.
4399
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004400
4401option logasap
4402no option logasap
4403 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4405 yes | yes | yes | no
4406 Arguments : none
4407
4408 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4409 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4410 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4411 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4412 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4413 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4414 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004415 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004416 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4417 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4418
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004419 Examples :
4420 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4421 mode http
4422 option httplog
4423 option logasap
4424 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4425
4426 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4427 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4428 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4429 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4430
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004431 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004432 logging.
4433
4434
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004435option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4436 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4438 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004439 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004440 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4441 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004442
4443 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4444 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4445 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4446 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4447 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4448 in the MySQL table, like this :
4449
4450 USE mysql;
4451 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4452 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4453
4454 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4455 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4456 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4457 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4458 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4459 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4460 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4461 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4462 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4463
4464 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4465 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004466
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004467 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004468
4469 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4470 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4471 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4472 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4473 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4474 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4475
4476 See also: "option httpchk"
4477
4478
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004479option nolinger
4480no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004481 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004482 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4483 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004484 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004485
4486 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4487 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4488 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4489 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4490 connections.
4491
4492 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4493 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4494 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4495 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4496 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4497 this too.
4498
4499 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4500 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4501 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4502
4503 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4504 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4505 for servers.
4506
4507 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4508 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4509
4510
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004511option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4512 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4514 yes | yes | yes | yes
4515 Arguments :
4516 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4517 matching <network>
4518 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4519 header name.
4520
4521 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4522 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4523 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4524 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4525 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4526 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4527 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4528 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4529 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4530 possible that the client has already brought one.
4531
4532 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4533 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4534 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4535 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4536 header and requires different one.
4537
4538 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4539 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4540 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4541 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4542 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4543 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4544 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4545
4546 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4547 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4548 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4549 both are defined.
4550
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004551 Examples :
4552 # Original Destination address
4553 frontend www
4554 mode http
4555 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4556
4557 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4558 backend www
4559 mode http
4560 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4561
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004562 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4563 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004564
4565
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004566option persist
4567no option persist
4568 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4569 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4570 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004571 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004572
4573 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4574 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4575 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4576 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4577 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4578 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4579 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4580 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4581 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4582 redirected to another valid server.
4583
4584 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4585 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4586
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004587 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004588
4589
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004590option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4591 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4593 yes | no | yes | yes
4594 Arguments :
4595 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4596 PostgreSQL server.
4597
4598 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4599 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4600 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4601 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4602
4603 See also: "option httpchk"
4604
4605
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004606option prefer-last-server
4607no option prefer-last-server
4608 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4609 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4610 yes | no | yes | yes
4611 Arguments : none
4612
4613 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4614 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4615 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4616 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4617 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4618 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4619 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4620 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4621 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004622 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4623 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4624 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4625 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4626 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4627 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4628 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004629
4630 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4631 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4632
4633 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4634
4635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004636option redispatch
4637no option redispatch
4638 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4639 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4640 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004641 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004642
4643 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4644 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4645 be able to access the service anymore.
4646
4647 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4648 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4649
4650 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4651 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4652 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004653
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004654 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4655 "redisp" keywords.
4656
4657 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4658 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4659
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004660 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004661
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004662
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004663option redis-check
4664 Use redis health checks for server testing
4665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4666 yes | no | yes | yes
4667 Arguments : none
4668
4669 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4670 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4671 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4672 find the "+PONG" response message.
4673
4674 Example :
4675 option redis-check
4676
4677 See also : "option httpchk"
4678
4679
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004680option smtpchk
4681option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4682 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4684 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004685 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004686 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4687 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4688 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4689
4690 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4691 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4692 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4693
4694 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4695 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4696 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4697 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4698 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4699 dead server.
4700
4701 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4702 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4703 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4704 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4705
4706 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4707 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4708 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4709 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4710 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4711
4712 Example :
4713 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4714
4715 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4716
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004717
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004718option socket-stats
4719no option socket-stats
4720
4721 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4723 yes | yes | yes | no
4724
4725 Arguments : none
4726
4727
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004728option splice-auto
4729no option splice-auto
4730 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4732 yes | yes | yes | yes
4733 Arguments : none
4734
4735 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4736 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4737 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4738 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004739 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004740 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4741 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4742 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4743 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4744
4745 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4746 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4747 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4748 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4749 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4750 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4751 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4752 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4753 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4754 keyword.
4755
4756 Example :
4757 option splice-auto
4758
4759 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4760 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4761
4762 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4763 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4764
4765
4766option splice-request
4767no option splice-request
4768 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4770 yes | yes | yes | yes
4771 Arguments : none
4772
4773 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004774 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004775 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4776 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4777 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4778 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4779
4780 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4781
4782 Example :
4783 option splice-request
4784
4785 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4786 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4787
4788 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4789 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4790
4791
4792option splice-response
4793no option splice-response
4794 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4796 yes | yes | yes | yes
4797 Arguments : none
4798
4799 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004800 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004801 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4802 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4803 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4804 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4805
4806 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4807
4808 Example :
4809 option splice-response
4810
4811 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4812 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4813
4814 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4815 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4816
4817
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004818option srvtcpka
4819no option srvtcpka
4820 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4822 yes | no | yes | yes
4823 Arguments : none
4824
4825 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4826 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4827 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4828 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4829
4830 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4831 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4832 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4833 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4834
4835 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4836 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4837 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4838 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4839 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4840
4841 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4842
4843 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4844 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4845 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4846
4847 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4848 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4849
4850 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4851
4852
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004853option ssl-hello-chk
4854 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4856 yes | no | yes | yes
4857 Arguments : none
4858
4859 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4860 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4861 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4862 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4863 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4864 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4865 hello message.
4866
4867 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4868 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4869 messages, which is appreciable.
4870
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004871 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4872 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4873 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004874
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004875 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4876
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004877
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004878option tcp-check
4879 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4880 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4881 yes | no | yes | yes
4882
4883 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4884 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4885
4886 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4887 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4888 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4889
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004890 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004891 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4892 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4893 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4894 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4895 only.
4896
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004897 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004898 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4899 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4900 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4901 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4902
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004903 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004904 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4905 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004906 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004907 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4908 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4909 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4910 the respective protocols.
4911 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4912 analysed.
4913
4914 Examples :
4915 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4916 option tcp-check
4917 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4918
4919 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4920 option tcp-check
4921 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4922
4923 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4924 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004925 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004926 option tcp-check
4927 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4928 tcp-check expect +PONG
4929 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4930 tcp-check expect string role:master
4931 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4932 tcp-check expect string +OK
4933
4934 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4935 (send many headers before analyzing)
4936 option tcp-check
4937 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4938 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4939 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4940 tcp-check send \r\n
4941 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4942
4943
4944 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4945
4946
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004947option tcp-smart-accept
4948no option tcp-smart-accept
4949 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4951 yes | yes | yes | no
4952 Arguments : none
4953
4954 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4955 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4956 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4957 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4958 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4959 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4960
4961 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4962 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4963 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4964 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4965
4966 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4967 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4968 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4969 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4970
4971 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4972 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4973 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4974
4975 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4976 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4977 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4978
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004979 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4980
4981
4982option tcp-smart-connect
4983no option tcp-smart-connect
4984 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4986 yes | no | yes | yes
4987 Arguments : none
4988
4989 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4990 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4991 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4992 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4993 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4994
4995 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4996 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4997 complex.
4998
4999 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5000 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5001 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5002
5003 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5004 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5005
5006 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5007
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005008
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005009option tcpka
5010 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5012 yes | yes | yes | yes
5013 Arguments : none
5014
5015 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5016 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5017 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5018 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5019
5020 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5021 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5022 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5023 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5024
5025 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5026 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5027 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5028 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5029 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5030
5031 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5032
5033 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5034 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5035 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5036 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5037 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5038 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5039 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5040 backends.
5041
5042 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5043
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005044
5045option tcplog
5046 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5048 yes | yes | yes | yes
5049 Arguments : none
5050
5051 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5052 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5053 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5054 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5055 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5056 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5057 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5058 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5059
5060 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5061
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005062 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005063
5064
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005065option transparent
5066no option transparent
5067 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005069 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005070 Arguments : none
5071
5072 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5073 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5074 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5075 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5076 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5077 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5078 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5079 appropriate server.
5080
5081 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5082 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5083
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005084 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005085 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005086
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005087
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005088persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005089persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005090 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5092 yes | no | yes | yes
5093 Arguments :
5094 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005095 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5096 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005097
5098 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5099 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5100 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5101 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5102 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5103 forwarded to this server.
5104
5105 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5106 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5107 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005108 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005109 a single "listen" section.
5110
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005111 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5112 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5113 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5114
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005115 Example :
5116 listen tse-farm
5117 bind :3389
5118 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5119 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5120 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5121 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5122 persist rdp-cookie
5123 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005124 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005125 balance rdp-cookie
5126 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5127 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5128
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005129 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5130 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005131
5132
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005133rate-limit sessions <rate>
5134 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5136 yes | yes | yes | no
5137 Arguments :
5138 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5139 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5140
5141 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5142 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5143 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5144 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5145 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5146 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5147
5148 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5149 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5150 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5151 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5152
5153 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5154 listen smtp
5155 mode tcp
5156 bind :25
5157 rate-limit sessions 10
5158 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5159
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005160 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5161 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5162 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005163
5164 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5165
5166
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005167redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5168redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5169redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005170 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5172 no | yes | yes | yes
5173
5174 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005175 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005176
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005177 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005178 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005179 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5180 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5181 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005182
5183 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5184 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5185 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5186 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5187 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005188 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5189 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5190 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5191 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005192
5193 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5194 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5195 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5196 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5197 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5198 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005199 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005200 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005201 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5202 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5203 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005204
5205 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005206 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5207 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5208 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5209 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5210 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5211 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5212 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5213 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005214
5215 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5216 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5217
5218 - "drop-query"
5219 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5220 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5221 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5222 with a location-type redirect.
5223
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005224 - "append-slash"
5225 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5226 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5227 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5228 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5229
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005230 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5231 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5232 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5233 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5234 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5235 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5236 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5237
5238 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5239 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5240 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5241 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5242 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5243 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5244 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005245
5246 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5247 acl clear dst_port 80
5248 acl secure dst_port 8080
5249 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005250 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005251 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005252 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5253
5254 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005255 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5256 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5257 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005258 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005259
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005260 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5261 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5262 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5263
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005264 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005265 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005266
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005267 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5268 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5269 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005271 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005272
5273
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005274redisp (deprecated)
5275redispatch (deprecated)
5276 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5277 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5278 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005279 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005280
5281 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5282 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5283 be able to access the service anymore.
5284
5285 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5286 redistribute them to a working server.
5287
5288 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5289 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5290 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005291
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005292 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5293 "option redispatch" instead.
5294
5295 See also : "option redispatch"
5296
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005297
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005298reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005299 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5301 no | yes | yes | yes
5302 Arguments :
5303 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5304 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005305 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005306
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005307 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5308 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5309
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005310 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5311 the last header of an HTTP request.
5312
5313 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5314 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5315 responses.
5316
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005317 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5318 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5319 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5320
5321 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5322 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005323
5324
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005325reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5326reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005327 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5329 no | yes | yes | yes
5330 Arguments :
5331 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5332 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5333 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5334 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5335 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5336 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5337 ignores case.
5338
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005339 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5340 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5341
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005342 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5343 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5344 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5345 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005346 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005347
5348 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5349 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5350
5351 Example :
5352 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5353 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5354 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5355
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005356 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5357 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005358
5359
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005360reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5361reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005362 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5364 no | yes | yes | yes
5365 Arguments :
5366 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5367 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5368 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5369 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5370 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5371 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5372
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005373 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5374 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5375
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005376 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5377 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5378 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5379 next servers.
5380
5381 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5382 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5383 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5384
5385 Example :
5386 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5387 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5388 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5389
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005390 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5391 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005392
5393
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005394reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5395reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005396 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5398 no | yes | yes | yes
5399 Arguments :
5400 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5401 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5402 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5403 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5404 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5405 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5406 case.
5407
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005408 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5409 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5410
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005411 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5412 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5413 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5414 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005415 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005416
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005417 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005418 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005419 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005420
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005421 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5422 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5423
5424 Example :
5425 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5426 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5427 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5428
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005429 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5430 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005431
5432
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005433reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5434reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005435 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5437 no | yes | yes | yes
5438 Arguments :
5439 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5440 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5441 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5442 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5443 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5444 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5445 case.
5446
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005447 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5448 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5449
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005450 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5451 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5452 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5453 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5454
5455 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5456 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5457
5458 Example :
5459 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5460 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5461 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5462 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5463
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005464 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5465 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005466
5467
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005468reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5469reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005470 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5472 no | yes | yes | yes
5473 Arguments :
5474 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5475 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5476 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5477 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5478 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5479 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5480
5481 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5482 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5483 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5484 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005485 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005486
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005487 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5488 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5489
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005490 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5491 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5492 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5493
5494 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5495 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5496 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5497 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5498 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5499
5500 Example :
5501 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005502 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005503 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5504 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5505
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005506 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5507 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005508
5509
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005510reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5511reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005512 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5514 no | yes | yes | yes
5515 Arguments :
5516 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5517 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5518 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5519 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5520 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5521 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5522 ignores case.
5523
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005524 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5525 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5526
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005527 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5528 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005529 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5530 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5531 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005532 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5533 not set.
5534
5535 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5536 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5537 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5538 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5539 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5540
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005541 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005542 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5543 # block all others.
5544 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5545 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5546
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005547 # block bad guys
5548 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5549 reqitarpit . if badguys
5550
5551 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5552 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005553
5554
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005555retries <value>
5556 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5557 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5558 yes | no | yes | yes
5559 Arguments :
5560 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5561 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5562 default value is 3.
5563
5564 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5565 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5566 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5567
5568 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5569 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5570
5571 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5572 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5573
5574 See also : "option redispatch"
5575
5576
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005577rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005578 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5580 no | yes | yes | yes
5581 Arguments :
5582 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5583 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005584 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005585
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005586 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5587 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5588
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005589 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5590 the last header of an HTTP response.
5591
5592 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5593 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5594 responses.
5595
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005596 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5597 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005598
5599
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005600rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5601rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005602 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5604 no | yes | yes | yes
5605 Arguments :
5606 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5607 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5608 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5609 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5610 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5611 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5612 ignores case.
5613
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005614 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5615 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5616
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005617 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5618 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005619 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005620 client.
5621
5622 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5623 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5624 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5625
5626 Example :
5627 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005628 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005629
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005630 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5631 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005632
5633
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005634rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5635rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005636 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5638 no | yes | yes | yes
5639 Arguments :
5640 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5641 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5642 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5643 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5644 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5645 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5646 ignores case.
5647
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005648 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5649 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5650
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005651 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5652 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5653 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5654 case-sensitive.
5655
5656 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005657 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5658 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5659 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005660
5661 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5662 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5663
5664 Example :
5665 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5666 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5667
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005668 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5669 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005670
5671
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005672rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5673rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005674 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5676 no | yes | yes | yes
5677 Arguments :
5678 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5679 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5680 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5681 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5682 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5683 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5684 ignores case.
5685
5686 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5687 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5688 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5689 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005690 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005691
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005692 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5693 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5694
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005695 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5696 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5697 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5698
5699 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5700 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5701 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5702 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5703 are not case-sensitive.
5704
5705 Example :
5706 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5707 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5708
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005709 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5710 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005711
5712
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005713server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005714 Declare a server in a backend
5715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5716 no | no | yes | yes
5717 Arguments :
5718 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005719 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005720 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005721
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005722 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5723 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5724 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5725 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005726 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5727 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5728 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5729 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5730 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005731 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5732 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5733 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5734 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5735 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5736 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5737 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005738 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5739 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5740 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5741 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005742
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005743 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005744 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5745 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5746 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5747 adding this value to the client's port.
5748
5749 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5750 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005751 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005752
5753 Examples :
5754 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5755 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005756 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005757 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5758 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5759 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005760
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005761 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5762 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005763
5764
5765source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005766source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005767source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005768 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5770 yes | no | yes | yes
5771 Arguments :
5772 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5773 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005774
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005775 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005776 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5777 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5778 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5779 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5780 supported prefixes are :
5781 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5782 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5783 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005784 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5785 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5786 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5787 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005788
5789 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5790 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005791 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5792 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5793 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005794
5795 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5796 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5797 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5798 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5799 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5800 <addr>.
5801
5802 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5803 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5804 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5805 port.
5806
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005807 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5808 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5809 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5810 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005811 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005812 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5813 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5814 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5815 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5816 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5817 HTTP header.
5818
5819 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5820 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005821 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005822 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5823 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5824 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5825 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5826 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5827 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5828 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5829
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005830 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5831 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5832 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5833 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5834 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5835 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5836
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005837 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5838 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5839 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5840 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5841
5842 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5843 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5844 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5845 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5846 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5847 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5848
5849 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5850 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5851 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5852 there are two methods :
5853
5854 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5855 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5856 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5857 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5858 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5859 of the client ranges may be used.
5860
5861 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5862 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5863 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5864 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5865 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5866 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5867 same session.
5868
5869 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5870 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5871 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5872 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5873 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5874 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5875
5876 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5877 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5878 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005879 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005880
5881 Examples :
5882 backend private
5883 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5884 source 192.168.1.200
5885
5886 backend transparent_ssl1
5887 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5888 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5889
5890 backend transparent_ssl2
5891 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5892 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5893 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5894
5895 backend transparent_ssl3
5896 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5897 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5898 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5899
5900 backend transparent_smtp
5901 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5902 # with Tproxy version 4.
5903 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5904
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005905 backend transparent_http
5906 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5907 # proxy.
5908 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005910 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005911 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005913
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005914srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5915 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5917 yes | no | yes | yes
5918 Arguments :
5919 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5920 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5921 as explained at the top of this document.
5922
5923 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5924 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5925 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5926 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5927 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5928 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5929 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5930
5931 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5932 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5933 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5934 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5935 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005936 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005937 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005938 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005939
5940 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5941 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5942 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5943 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5944 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5945 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5946
5947 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5948 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5949
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005950 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5951 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005952
5953
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005954stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5955 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02005957 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005958
5959 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5960 matched.
5961
5962 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5963 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5964
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005965 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5966 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5967 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5968
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005969 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5970 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5971 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5972 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005973
5974 Example :
5975 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5976 backend stats_localhost
5977 stats enable
5978 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5979
5980 Example :
5981 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5982 backend stats_auth
5983 stats enable
5984 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5985 stats admin if TRUE
5986
5987 Example :
5988 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5989 userlist stats-auth
5990 group admin users admin
5991 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5992 group readonly users haproxy
5993 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5994
5995 backend stats_auth
5996 stats enable
5997 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5998 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5999 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6000 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6001
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006002 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6003 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6004 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006005
6006
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006007stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6008 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006010 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006011 Arguments :
6012 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6013
6014 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6015
6016 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6017 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6018 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6019 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6020 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6021 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6022
6023 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6024 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6025 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006026 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006027
6028 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6029 report using "stats scope".
6030
6031 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6032 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6033 unobvious parameters.
6034
6035 Example :
6036 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6037 backend public_www
6038 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6039 stats enable
6040 stats hide-version
6041 stats scope .
6042 stats uri /admin?stats
6043 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6044 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6045 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6046
6047 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6048 backend private_monitoring
6049 stats enable
6050 stats uri /admin?stats
6051 stats refresh 5s
6052
6053 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6054
6055
6056stats enable
6057 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006059 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006060 Arguments : none
6061
6062 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6063 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6064 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6065 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6066 - stats auth : no authentication
6067 - stats scope : no restriction
6068
6069 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6070 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6071 unobvious parameters.
6072
6073 Example :
6074 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6075 backend public_www
6076 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6077 stats enable
6078 stats hide-version
6079 stats scope .
6080 stats uri /admin?stats
6081 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6082 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6083 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6084
6085 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6086 backend private_monitoring
6087 stats enable
6088 stats uri /admin?stats
6089 stats refresh 5s
6090
6091 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6092
6093
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006094stats hide-version
6095 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006097 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006098 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006099
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006100 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6101 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6102 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6103 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6104 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6105 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006106
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006107 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6108 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6109 unobvious parameters.
6110
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006111 Example :
6112 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6113 backend public_www
6114 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006115 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006116 stats hide-version
6117 stats scope .
6118 stats uri /admin?stats
6119 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6120 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6121 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006122
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006123 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6124 backend private_monitoring
6125 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006126 stats uri /admin?stats
6127 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006128
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006129 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006130
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006131
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006132stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6133 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6134 Access control for statistics
6135
6136 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6137 no | no | yes | yes
6138
6139 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6140 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6141 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6142 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6143 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6144 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6145
6146 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6147 instance.
6148
6149 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6150 about ACL usage.
6151
6152
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006153stats realm <realm>
6154 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006156 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006157 Arguments :
6158 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6159 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6160 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6161
6162 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6163 using a backslash ('\').
6164
6165 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6166 only related to authentication.
6167
6168 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6169 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6170 unobvious parameters.
6171
6172 Example :
6173 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6174 backend public_www
6175 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6176 stats enable
6177 stats hide-version
6178 stats scope .
6179 stats uri /admin?stats
6180 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6181 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6182 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6183
6184 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6185 backend private_monitoring
6186 stats enable
6187 stats uri /admin?stats
6188 stats refresh 5s
6189
6190 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6191
6192
6193stats refresh <delay>
6194 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006196 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006197 Arguments :
6198 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6199 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6200 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6201 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6202 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6203 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6204
6205 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6206 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6207 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6208 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6209
6210 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6211 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6212 unobvious parameters.
6213
6214 Example :
6215 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6216 backend public_www
6217 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6218 stats enable
6219 stats hide-version
6220 stats scope .
6221 stats uri /admin?stats
6222 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6223 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6224 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6225
6226 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6227 backend private_monitoring
6228 stats enable
6229 stats uri /admin?stats
6230 stats refresh 5s
6231
6232 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6233
6234
6235stats scope { <name> | "." }
6236 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006238 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006239 Arguments :
6240 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6241 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6242 section in which the statement appears.
6243
6244 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6245 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6246 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6247 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6248 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6249 exists.
6250
6251 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6252 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6253 unobvious parameters.
6254
6255 Example :
6256 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6257 backend public_www
6258 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6259 stats enable
6260 stats hide-version
6261 stats scope .
6262 stats uri /admin?stats
6263 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6264 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6265 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6266
6267 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6268 backend private_monitoring
6269 stats enable
6270 stats uri /admin?stats
6271 stats refresh 5s
6272
6273 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6274
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006275
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006276stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006277 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006279 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006280
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006281 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006282 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6283
6284 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6285 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6286
6287 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6288 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006289 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006290
6291 Example :
6292 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6293 backend private_monitoring
6294 stats enable
6295 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6296 stats uri /admin?stats
6297 stats refresh 5s
6298
6299 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6300 global section.
6301
6302
6303stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006304 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6306 yes | yes | yes | yes
6307 Arguments : none
6308
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006309 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006310 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6311 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6312 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6313 - IP (socket, server)
6314 - cookie (backend, server)
6315
6316 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6317 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006318 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006319
6320 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6321
6322
6323stats show-node [ <name> ]
6324 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006326 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006327 Arguments:
6328 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6329 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6330
6331 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6332 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006333 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006334
6335 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6336 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6337 unobvious parameters.
6338
6339 Example:
6340 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6341 backend private_monitoring
6342 stats enable
6343 stats show-node Europe-1
6344 stats uri /admin?stats
6345 stats refresh 5s
6346
6347 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6348 section.
6349
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006350
6351stats uri <prefix>
6352 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006354 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006355 Arguments :
6356 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6357 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6358 query string.
6359
6360 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6361 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6362 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6363 possible to reach it in the application.
6364
6365 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006366 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006367 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6368 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6369 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6370 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6371
6372 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6373 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6374 an address or a port to statistics only.
6375
6376 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6377 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6378 unobvious parameters.
6379
6380 Example :
6381 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6382 backend public_www
6383 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6384 stats enable
6385 stats hide-version
6386 stats scope .
6387 stats uri /admin?stats
6388 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6389 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6390 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6391
6392 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6393 backend private_monitoring
6394 stats enable
6395 stats uri /admin?stats
6396 stats refresh 5s
6397
6398 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6399
6400
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006401stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6402 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006404 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006405
6406 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006407 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006408 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6409 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6410 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6411
6412 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6413 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6414 the "stick-table" statement.
6415
6416 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6417 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6418 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6419 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6420 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6421
6422 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6423 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6424 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6425 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6426 transformation rules.
6427
6428 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6429 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6430 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6431 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6432 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6433 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6434 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6435
6436 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6437 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6438 ACL based conditions.
6439
6440 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6441 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6442 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6443 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6444
6445 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6446 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6447 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6448 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6449
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006450 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6451 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6452 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6453
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006454 Example :
6455 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6456 # last 30 minutes
6457 backend pop
6458 mode tcp
6459 balance roundrobin
6460 stick store-request src
6461 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6462 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6463 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6464
6465 backend smtp
6466 mode tcp
6467 balance roundrobin
6468 stick match src table pop
6469 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6470 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6471
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006472 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6473 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006474
6475
6476stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6477 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6479 no | no | yes | yes
6480
6481 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6482 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6483 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6484 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6485
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006486 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6487 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6488 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6489
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006490 Examples :
6491 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006492 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006493
6494 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6495 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6496 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6497
6498
6499 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6500 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6501 backend http
6502 mode http
6503 balance roundrobin
6504 stick on src table https
6505 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6506 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6507 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6508
6509 backend https
6510 mode tcp
6511 balance roundrobin
6512 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6513 stick on src
6514 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6515 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6516
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006517 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006518
6519
6520stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6521 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6523 no | no | yes | yes
6524
6525 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006526 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006527 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6528 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6529 server is selected.
6530
6531 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6532 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6533 the "stick-table" statement.
6534
6535 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6536 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6537 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6538 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6539 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6540 address.
6541
6542 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6543 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6544 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6545 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6546 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6547 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6548 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6549 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6550 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6551 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6552
6553 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6554 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6555 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6556 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6557 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6558 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6559 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6560
6561 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6562 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6563 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6564 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6565
6566 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6567 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6568 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6569 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6570 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6571 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006572 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6573 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6574 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6575 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6576 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6577 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006578
6579 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6580 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6581 the request.
6582
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006583 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6584 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6585 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6586
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006587 Example :
6588 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6589 # last 30 minutes
6590 backend pop
6591 mode tcp
6592 balance roundrobin
6593 stick store-request src
6594 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6595 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6596 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6597
6598 backend smtp
6599 mode tcp
6600 balance roundrobin
6601 stick match src table pop
6602 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6603 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6604
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006605 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6606 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006607
6608
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006609stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006610 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6611 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006612 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006614 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006615
6616 Arguments :
6617 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6618 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6619 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6620 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6621
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006622 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6623 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6624 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6625 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6626
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006627 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6628 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6629 instance.
6630
6631 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6632 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6633 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6634 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6635 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6636 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006637 to 32 characters.
6638
6639 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6640 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6641 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6642 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6643 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6644 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006645
6646 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006647 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6648 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006649 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6650 increase.
6651
6652 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006653 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6654 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6655 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006656
6657 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6658 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6659 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6660 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6661 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6662 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6663 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6664 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6665 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6666 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6667 parameter (see below).
6668
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006669 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6670 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6671 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6672 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6673 soft restart.
6674
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006675 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6676
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006677 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6678 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6679 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6680 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6681 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006682 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006683 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6684 if not expiration delay is specified.
6685
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006686 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6687 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6688 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6689 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006690 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6691 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6692 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6693 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6694 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6695 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6696 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6697 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6698 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6699 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6700 types and their arguments.
6701
6702 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6703 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6704 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6705 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6706
6707 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6708 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6709 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6710 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6711
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006712 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6713 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6714 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6715 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6716 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6717 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6718
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006719 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6720 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6721 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6722 they were received.
6723
6724 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6725 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6726 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6727 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6728 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6729
6730 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6731 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6732 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6733 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6734 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6735
6736 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6737 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6738 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6739
6740 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6741 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6742 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6743 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6744 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6745
6746 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6747 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6748 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6749 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6750 the client side.
6751
6752 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6753 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6754 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6755 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6756 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6757 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6758 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6759
6760 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6761 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6762 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6763 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6764 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6765 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6766 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6767
6768 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6769 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6770 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6771 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6772 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6773 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6774
6775 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6776 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6777 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6778 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6779
6780 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6781 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6782 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6783 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6784 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6785 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6786 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6787 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6788 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6789 recommended for better fairness.
6790
6791 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6792 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6793 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6794 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6795
6796 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6797 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6798 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6799 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6800 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6801 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6802 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6803 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6804 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6805 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006806
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006807 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6808 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006809 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6810 reference it.
6811
6812 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6813 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6814 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6815 as an exclusive stickiness.
6816
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006817 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6818 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6819 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6820 something that can be ignored.
6821
6822 Example:
6823 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6824 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6825 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6826 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6827
6828 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006829 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006830
6831
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006832stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6833 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6835 no | no | yes | yes
6836
6837 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006838 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006839 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6840 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6841 server is selected.
6842
6843 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6844 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6845 the "stick-table" statement.
6846
6847 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6848 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6849 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6850 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6851
6852 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6853 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6854 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6855 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6856 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6857 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006858 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006859 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6860 rules.
6861
6862 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6863 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6864 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6865 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6866 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6867 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6868 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6869
6870 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6871 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6872 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6873 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6874
6875 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6876 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6877 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6878 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6879 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6880 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006881 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6882 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6883 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6884 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6885 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6886 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6887 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6888 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6889 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006890
6891 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6892
6893 Example :
6894 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6895 backend https
6896 mode tcp
6897 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006898 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006899 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006900
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006901 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6902 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6903
6904 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6905 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6906 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6907
6908 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6909 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006910
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006911 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6912 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6913 # at offset 44.
6914
6915 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6916 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6917
6918 # Learn on response if server hello.
6919 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006920
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006921 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6922 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6923
6924 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6925 extraction.
6926
6927
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02006928tcp-check connect [params*]
6929 Opens a new connection
6930 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6931 no | no | yes | yes
6932
6933 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
6934 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
6935 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
6936
6937 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6938 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
6939 of the sequence.
6940
6941 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6942 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6943 do.
6944
6945 Parameters :
6946 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
6947 use the TCP connection.
6948
6949 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
6950 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6951 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
6952
6953 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6954
6955 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6956
6957 Examples:
6958 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6959 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6960 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6961 option tcp-check
6962 tcp-check connect
6963 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
6964 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
6965 tcp-check send \r\n
6966 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
6967 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
6968 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
6969 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
6970 tcp-check send \r\n
6971 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
6972 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
6973
6974 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
6975 option tcp-check
6976 tcp-check connect port 110
6977 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
6978 tcp-check connect port 143
6979 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
6980 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
6981
6982 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
6983
6984
6985tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
6986 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
6987 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6988 no | no | yes | yes
6989
6990 Arguments :
6991 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
6992 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
6993 binary.
6994 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
6995 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
6996 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
6997
6998 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
6999 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7000 with the usual backslash ('\').
7001 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7002 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7003 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7004 used upper or lower case.
7005
7006
7007 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7008
7009 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7010 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7011 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7012 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7013 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7014 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7015 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7016 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7017
7018 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7019 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7020 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7021 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7022 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7023 expression.
7024
7025 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7026 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7027 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7028 this exact hexadecimal string.
7029 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7030
7031 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7032 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7033 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7034 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7035 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7036 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7037 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7038 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7039 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7040 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7041 the null character.
7042
7043 Examples :
7044 # perform a POP check
7045 option tcp-check
7046 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7047
7048 # perform an IMAP check
7049 option tcp-check
7050 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7051
7052 # look for the redis master server
7053 option tcp-check
7054 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7055 tcp-check expect +PONG
7056 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7057 tcp-check expect string role:master
7058 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7059 tcp-check expect string +OK
7060
7061
7062 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7063 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7064
7065
7066tcp-check send <data>
7067 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7068 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7069 no | no | yes | yes
7070
7071 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7072 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7073
7074 Examples :
7075 # look for the redis master server
7076 option tcp-check
7077 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7078 tcp-check expect string role:master
7079
7080 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7081 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7082
7083
7084tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7085 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7086 tcp health check
7087 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7088 no | no | yes | yes
7089
7090 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7091 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7092 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7093 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7094 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7095 hexadecimal string.
7096 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7097
7098 Examples :
7099 # redis check in binary
7100 option tcp-check
7101 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7102 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7103
7104
7105 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7106 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7107
7108
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007109tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7110 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7112 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007113 Arguments :
7114 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007115 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7116 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007117
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007118 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007119
7120 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7121 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007122 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7123 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7124 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7125 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7126 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7127 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007128
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007129 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7130 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7131 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7132 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007133
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007134 Three types of actions are supported :
7135 - accept :
7136 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7137 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7138 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007139
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007140 - reject :
7141 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7142 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7143 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7144 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7145 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7146 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7147 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7148 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7149 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7150 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7151 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7152 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007153
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007154 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7155 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7156 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7157 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7158 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7159 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7160 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7161 hosts.
7162
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007163 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007164 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7165 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7166 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007167 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7168 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007169 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007170 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7171 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7172 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7173 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7174 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007175
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007176 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007177 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007178 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007179 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7180 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7181 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7182 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007183
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007184 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7185 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7186 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7187 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007188
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007189 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7190 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7191 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7192 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7193 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007194 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7195 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7196 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7197 layer7 information is extracted.
7198
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007199 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7200 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7201 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7202 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7203 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007204
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007205 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7206 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7207 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007208
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007209 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7210 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7211 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007212
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007213 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007214 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007215 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007216
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007217 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7218 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7219 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007220
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007221 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007222 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7223 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007224
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007225 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7226
7227 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7228
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007229 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7230
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007231 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007232
7233
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007234tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7235 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007237 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007238 Arguments :
7239 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007240 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7241 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02007242 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007243
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007244 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007245
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007246 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7247 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7248 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7249 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7250 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007251
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007252 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7253 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7254 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7255 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007256 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7257 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7258 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7259 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7260 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7261 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007262 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007263 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007264
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007265 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7266 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7267 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7268 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007269
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007270 Three types of actions are supported :
7271 - accept :
7272 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007273 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007274
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007275 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7276 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007277
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007278 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7279 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7280 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7281 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7282 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7283 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007284
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007285 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007286 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7287 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007288
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007289 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007290 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7291 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7292 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7293 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007294 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7295 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7296 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007297
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007298 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7299 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7300 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7301 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7302
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007303 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007304 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7305 # and reject everything else.
7306 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7307 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007308 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007309 tcp-request content reject
7310
7311 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007312 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7313 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7314 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007315 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007316
7317 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7318 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7319 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007320 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007321 tcp-request content reject
7322
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007323 Example:
7324 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7325 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007326 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007327
7328 Example:
7329 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7330 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007331 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007332
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007333 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7334 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7335
7336 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007337 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007338 # protecting all our sites
7339 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007340 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7341 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007342 ...
7343 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7344
7345 backend http_dynamic
7346 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007347 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007348 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007349 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7350 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7351 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007352 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007354 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007355
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007356 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007357
7358
7359tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7360 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007362 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007363 Arguments :
7364 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7365 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7366 as explained at the top of this document.
7367
7368 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7369 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7370 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7371 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7372 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7373
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007374 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7375 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7376 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7377 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7378
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007379 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7380 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007381 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007382 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007383 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7384 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7385 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7386 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007387
7388 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7389 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7390 it pass through unaffected.
7391
7392 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7393 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7394 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007395 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007396 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7397 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007398 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7399 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7400 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007401
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007402 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007403 "timeout client".
7404
7405
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007406tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7407 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7409 no | no | yes | yes
7410 Arguments :
7411 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007412 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007413
7414 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7415
7416 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7417 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7418 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007419 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7420 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007421
7422 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7423
7424 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7425 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7426 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7427 inserted.
7428
7429 Two types of actions are supported :
7430 - accept :
7431 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7432 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7433 the rules evaluation.
7434
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007435 - close :
7436 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7437 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7438 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7439 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7440 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7441 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007442 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007443 protocols.
7444
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007445 - reject :
7446 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7447 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007448 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007449
7450 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7451 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7452 for changing the default action to a reject.
7453
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007454 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7455 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7456 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7457 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007458 period.
7459
7460 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7461
7462 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7463
7464
7465tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7466 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7468 no | no | yes | yes
7469 Arguments :
7470 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7471 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7472 as explained at the top of this document.
7473
7474 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7475
7476
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007477timeout check <timeout>
7478 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7479 established.
7480
7481 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7482 yes | no | yes | yes
7483 Arguments:
7484 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7485 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7486 as explained at the top of this document.
7487
7488 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7489 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7490 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7491 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007492 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7493 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7494 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007495
7496 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7497 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7498
7499 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7500 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007501 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007502
7503 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7504 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7505 forget about it.
7506
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007507 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7508 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007509
7510
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007511timeout client <timeout>
7512timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7513 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7515 yes | yes | yes | no
7516 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007517 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007518 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7519 as explained at the top of this document.
7520
7521 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7522 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7523 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7524 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7525 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7526 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7527 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7528 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007529 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007530 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007531 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7532 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
7533 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007534
7535 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7536 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7537 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7538 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7539 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7540 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7541
7542 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7543 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7544 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7545
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007546 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007547
7548
7549timeout connect <timeout>
7550timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7551 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7553 yes | no | yes | yes
7554 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007555 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007556 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7557 as explained at the top of this document.
7558
7559 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007560 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007561 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007562 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007563 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7564 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007565
7566 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7567 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7568 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7569 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7570 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7571 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7572
7573 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7574 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7575 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7576
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007577 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7578 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007579
7580
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007581timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7582 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7584 yes | yes | yes | yes
7585 Arguments :
7586 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7587 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7588 as explained at the top of this document.
7589
7590 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7591 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7592 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7593 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7594 once the request has started to present itself.
7595
7596 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7597 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7598 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7599 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7600 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7601
7602 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7603 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7604 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7605 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7606
7607 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7608 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7609 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7610 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7611 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007612 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007613
7614 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7615 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7616 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7617 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7618
7619 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7620
7621
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007622timeout http-request <timeout>
7623 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007625 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007626 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007627 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007628 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7629 as explained at the top of this document.
7630
7631 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7632 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7633 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7634 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7635 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7636 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7637 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
7638 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7639
7640 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7641 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007642 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7643 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007644
7645 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7646 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7647 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7648 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7649 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7650
7651 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007652 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7653 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7654 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007655
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007656 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007657
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007658
7659timeout queue <timeout>
7660 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7662 yes | no | yes | yes
7663 Arguments :
7664 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7665 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7666 as explained at the top of this document.
7667
7668 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7669 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7670 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7671 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7672 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7673
7674 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7675 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7676 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7677 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7678
7679 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7680
7681
7682timeout server <timeout>
7683timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7684 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7686 yes | no | yes | yes
7687 Arguments :
7688 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7689 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7690 as explained at the top of this document.
7691
7692 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7693 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7694 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7695 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7696 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7697 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7698 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7699
7700 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7701 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7702 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7703 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7704 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007705 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007706 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007707 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7708 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7709 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7710 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007711
7712 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7713 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7714 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7715 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7716 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7717 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7718
7719 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7720 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7721 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7722
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007723 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007724
7725
7726timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007727 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7729 yes | yes | yes | yes
7730 Arguments :
7731 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7732 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7733 as explained at the top of this document.
7734
7735 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7736 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7737 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7738
7739 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7740 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7741 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7742 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007743 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007744
7745 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7746
7747
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007748timeout tunnel <timeout>
7749 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7751 yes | no | yes | yes
7752 Arguments :
7753 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7754 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7755 as explained at the top of this document.
7756
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007757 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007758 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7759 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7760 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7761 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7762 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7763 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7764 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7765 specified.
7766
7767 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7768 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7769 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7770 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7771 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7772
7773 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7774 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7775 forget about it.
7776
7777 Example :
7778 defaults http
7779 option http-server-close
7780 timeout connect 5s
7781 timeout client 30s
7782 timeout client 30s
7783 timeout server 30s
7784 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7785
7786 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7787
7788
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007789transparent (deprecated)
7790 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007792 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007793 Arguments : none
7794
7795 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7796 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7797 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7798 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7799 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7800 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7801 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7802 appropriate server.
7803
7804 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7805
7806 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7807 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7808
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007809 See also: "option transparent"
7810
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007811unique-id-format <string>
7812 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7814 yes | yes | yes | no
7815 Arguments :
7816 <string> is a log-format string.
7817
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007818 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7819 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7820 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7821 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007822
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007823 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7824 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7825 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7826 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7827 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7828 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7829 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7830 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007831
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007832 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7833 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007834
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007835 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007836
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007837 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007838
7839 will generate:
7840
7841 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7842
7843 See also: "unique-id-header"
7844
7845unique-id-header <name>
7846 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7848 yes | yes | yes | no
7849 Arguments :
7850 <name> is the name of the header.
7851
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007852 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7853 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007854
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007855 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007856
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007857 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007858 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7859
7860 will generate:
7861
7862 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7863
7864 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007865
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007866use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007867 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7869 no | yes | yes | no
7870 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007871 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
7872 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007873
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007874 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
7875 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007876
7877 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7878 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7879 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007880 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7881 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7882 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7883 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007884
7885 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7886 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7887 assign the backend.
7888
7889 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7890 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7891 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7892 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7893 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7894 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7895
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007896 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007897 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007898 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7899 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7900 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7901
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007902 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
7903 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
7904 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
7905 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
7906 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
7907 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
7908 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
7909 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
7910 cannot be forced from the request.
7911
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007912 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007913 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
7914 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
7915
7916 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
7917 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007918
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007919
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007920use-server <server> if <condition>
7921use-server <server> unless <condition>
7922 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7924 no | no | yes | yes
7925 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007926 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007927
7928 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7929
7930 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7931 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7932 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7933
7934 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7935 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7936 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7937 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7938 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7939 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7940 matches will assign the server.
7941
7942 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7943 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7944 with the next rules until one matches.
7945
7946 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7947 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7948 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7949 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7950
7951 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7952 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7953 stripped.
7954
7955 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7956 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7957 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7958 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7959
7960 Example :
7961 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7962 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7963 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7964 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7965 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7966 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7967 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7968 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7969 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7970
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007971 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007972
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007973
79745. Bind and Server options
7975--------------------------
7976
7977The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7978depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7979settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7980written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7981described in this section.
7982
7983
79845.1. Bind options
7985-----------------
7986
7987The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7988as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7989no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7990parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7991while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7992provided immediately after the setting name.
7993
7994The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7995
7996accept-proxy
7997 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7998 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7999 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8000 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8001 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8002 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8003 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8004 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8005 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008006 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8007 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008008
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008009alpn <protocols>
8010 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8011 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8012 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8013 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8014 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8015 initial NPN extension.
8016
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008017backlog <backlog>
8018 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8019 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8020
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008021ecdhe <named curve>
8022 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008023 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8024 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008025
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008026ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008027 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8028 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8029 client's certificate.
8030
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008031ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8032 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8033 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8034 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8035 error is ignored.
8036
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008037ciphers <ciphers>
8038 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8039 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008040 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008041 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8042 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8043
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008044crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008045 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8046 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8047 to verify client's certificate.
8048
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008049crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008050 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8051 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8052 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8053 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8054 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8055 file.
8056
8057 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8058 are loaded.
8059
8060 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
8061 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
8062 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8063 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8064 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8065 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8066 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8067 www.sub.example.org).
8068
8069 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8070 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8071 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8072 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8073 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8074
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008075 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008076
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008077 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8078 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008079 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008080 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8081 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8082 clients).
8083
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008084crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008085 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8086 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008087 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008088 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008089
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008090crt-list <file>
8091 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008092 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8093 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008094
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008095 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008096
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008097 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8098 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8099 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8100 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8101 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8102 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8103 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8104 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008105
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008106defer-accept
8107 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8108 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8109 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8110 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8111 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8112 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8113 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8114 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8115 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8116 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8117 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8118
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008119force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008120 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008121 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
8122 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8123
8124force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008125 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008126 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8127
8128force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008129 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008130 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8131
8132force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008133 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008134 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8135
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008136gid <gid>
8137 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8138 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8139 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8140 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8141 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8142
8143group <group>
8144 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8145 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8146 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8147 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8148 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8149
8150id <id>
8151 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8152 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8153 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8154 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8155
8156interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008157 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8158 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8159 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8160 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8161 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8162 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8163 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008164
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008165level <level>
8166 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8167 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8168 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8169 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8170 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8171 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8172 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8173 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8174 counters).
8175 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8176 all counters).
8177
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008178maxconn <maxconn>
8179 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8180 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8181 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8182 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8183 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8184 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8185 eat all memory.
8186
8187mode <mode>
8188 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8189 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8190 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8191 UNIX sockets.
8192
8193mss <maxseg>
8194 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8195 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8196 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8197 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8198 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8199 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8200 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8201 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8202 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8203 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8204 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8205
8206name <name>
8207 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8208 page.
8209
8210nice <nice>
8211 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8212 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8213 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8214 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8215 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8216 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8217 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8218 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8219 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8220 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8221 one for an RDP socket.
8222
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008223no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008224 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008225 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008226 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008227 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8228 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008229
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008230no-tls-tickets
8231 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8232 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8233 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8234 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8235
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008236no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008237 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008238 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008239 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8240 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8241 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008242
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008243no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008244 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008245 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008246 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8247 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8248 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008249
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008250no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008251 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008252 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008253 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8254 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8255 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008256
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008257npn <protocols>
8258 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8259 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8260 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8261 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008262 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8263 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008264
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008265ssl
8266 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008267 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008268 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8269 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8270 to deciphered contents.
8271
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008272strict-sni
8273 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8274 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8275 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8276 See the "crt" option for more information.
8277
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008278tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008279 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008280 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8281 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8282 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8283 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8284 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8285 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8286 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008287 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8288 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8289 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008290
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008291transparent
8292 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8293 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8294 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8295 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8296 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8297 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8298 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8299 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8300 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8301 so check for support with your vendor.
8302
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008303v4v6
8304 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8305 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8306 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8307 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008308 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008309
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008310v6only
8311 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8312 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8313 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008314 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8315 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008316
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008317uid <uid>
8318 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8319 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8320 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8321 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8322 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8323
8324user <user>
8325 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8326 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8327 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8328 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8329 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8330
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008331verify [none|optional|required]
8332 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8333 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8334 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8335 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8336 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008337 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8338 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8339 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8340 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008341
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020083425.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008343------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008344
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008345The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8346which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8347arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8348settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8349after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8350Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8351address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008352
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008353 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008354 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008355
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008356The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008357
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008358addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008359 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8360 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8361 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8362 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8363 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008365 Supported in default-server: No
8366
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008367agent-check
8368 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
8369 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
8370 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
8371 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
8372
8373 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
8374 e.g. "75%"
8375
8376 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8377 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8378
8379 * The string "drain".
8380
8381 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
8382 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
8383 persistence.
8384
8385 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
8386
8387 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
8388
8389 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
8390
8391 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8392
8393 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
8394
8395 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8396
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008397 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8398 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
8399 parameter.
8400
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008401 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
8402 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
8403
8404 Supported in default-server: No
8405
8406agent-inter <delay>
8407 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8408 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8409
8410 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8411 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8412 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8413 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8414 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8415 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8416 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8417 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8418 of backends use the same servers.
8419
8420 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8421
8422 Supported in default-server: Yes
8423
8424agent-port <port>
8425 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8426
8427 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8428
8429 Supported in default-server: Yes
8430
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008431backup
8432 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8433 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8434 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8435 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8436 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8437 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008438
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008439 Supported in default-server: No
8440
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008441ca-file <cafile>
8442 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8443 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8444 server's certificate.
8445
8446 Supported in default-server: No
8447
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008448check
8449 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008450 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8451 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8452 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8453 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8454 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8455 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8456 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008457 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8458 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8459 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008460
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008461 Supported in default-server: No
8462
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008463check-send-proxy
8464 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8465 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8466 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8467 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8468 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8469 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8470 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8471
8472 Supported in default-server: No
8473
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008474check-ssl
8475 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8476 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8477 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8478 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008479 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008480 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8481 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8482 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8483 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8484
8485 Supported in default-server: No
8486
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008487ciphers <ciphers>
8488 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008489 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008490 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8491 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8492 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8493 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8494 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8495 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8496
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008497 Supported in default-server: No
8498
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008499cookie <value>
8500 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8501 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8502 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8503 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8504 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8505 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8506 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8507
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008508 Supported in default-server: No
8509
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008510crl-file <crlfile>
8511 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8512 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8513 to verify server's certificate.
8514
8515 Supported in default-server: No
8516
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008517crt <cert>
8518 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8519 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8520 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8521 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8522 certificate request.
8523
8524 Supported in default-server: No
8525
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008526disabled
8527 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8528 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8529 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8530 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8531 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8532
8533 Supported in default-server: No
8534
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008535error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008536 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8537 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8538 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008539
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008540 Supported in default-server: Yes
8541
8542 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008543
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008544fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008545 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8546 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8547 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008549 Supported in default-server: Yes
8550
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008551force-sslv3
8552 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8553 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8554 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8555
8556 Supported in default-server: No
8557
8558force-tlsv10
8559 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8560 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8561
8562 Supported in default-server: No
8563
8564force-tlsv11
8565 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8566 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8567
8568 Supported in default-server: No
8569
8570force-tlsv12
8571 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8572 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8573
8574 Supported in default-server: No
8575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008576id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008577 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8578 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8579 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008581 Supported in default-server: No
8582
8583inter <delay>
8584fastinter <delay>
8585downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008586 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8587 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8588 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8589 between checks depending on the server state :
8590
8591 Server state | Interval used
8592 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8593 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8594 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8595 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8596 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8597 or yet unchecked. |
8598 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8599 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8600 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008601
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008602 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8603 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8604 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8605 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008606 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8607 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8608 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8609 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8610 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008611
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008612 Supported in default-server: Yes
8613
8614maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008615 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8616 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8617 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8618 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8619 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8620 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8621 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8622 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8623
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008624 Supported in default-server: Yes
8625
8626maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008627 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8628 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8629 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8630 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8631 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8632 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8633 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8634
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008635 Supported in default-server: Yes
8636
8637minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008638 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8639 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8640 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8641 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8642 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8643 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008644 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008645 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008646
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008647 Supported in default-server: Yes
8648
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008649no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008650 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8651 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008652 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008653
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008654 Supported in default-server: No
8655
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008656no-tls-tickets
8657 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8658 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8659 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8660 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8661
8662 Supported in default-server: No
8663
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008664no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008665 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008666 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8667 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008668 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8669 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008670
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008671 Supported in default-server: No
8672
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008673no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008674 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008675 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8676 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008677 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8678 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008679
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008680 Supported in default-server: No
8681
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008682no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008683 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008684 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8685 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008686 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8687 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008688
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008689 Supported in default-server: No
8690
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008691non-stick
8692 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8693 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8694 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8695
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008696 Supported in default-server: No
8697
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008698observe <mode>
8699 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8700 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8701 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8702 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8703 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8704 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008705 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008707 Supported in default-server: No
8708
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008709 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8710
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008711on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008712 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8713 Currently, four modes are available:
8714 - fastinter: force fastinter
8715 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8716 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8717 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8718 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8719
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008720 Supported in default-server: Yes
8721
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008722 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8723
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008724on-marked-down <action>
8725 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8726 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008727 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8728 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8729 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8730 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8731 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8732 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8733 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8734 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008735
8736 Actions are disabled by default
8737
8738 Supported in default-server: Yes
8739
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008740on-marked-up <action>
8741 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8742 Currently one action is available:
8743 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8744 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8745 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8746 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8747 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8748 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8749 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8750 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8751
8752 Actions are disabled by default
8753
8754 Supported in default-server: Yes
8755
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008756port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008757 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8758 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8759 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8760 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8761 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8762 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8763
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008764 Supported in default-server: Yes
8765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008766redir <prefix>
8767 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8768 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8769 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8770 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8771 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8772 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8773 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8774 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008775 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008776 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8777 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8778 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8779 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8780 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8781
8782 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8783
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008784 Supported in default-server: No
8785
8786rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008787 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8788 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8789 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8790
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008791 Supported in default-server: Yes
8792
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008793send-proxy
8794 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8795 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8796 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8797 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8798 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8799 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8800 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8801 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8802 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008803 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8804 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8805 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8806 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8807 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008808
8809 Supported in default-server: No
8810
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008811slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008812 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8813 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8814 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8815 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8816 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8817 parameters :
8818
8819 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8820 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8821
8822 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8823 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8824 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8825 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8826
8827 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8828 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8829 seen as failed.
8830
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008831 Supported in default-server: Yes
8832
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008833source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008834source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008835source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008836 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8837 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8838 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8839 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8840
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008841 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8842 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8843 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8844 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8845 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8846 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8847 server.
8848
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008849 Supported in default-server: No
8850
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008851ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008852 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8853 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8854 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8855 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8856 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8857 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008858 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008859
8860 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008862track [<proxy>/]<server>
8863 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8864 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8865 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8866 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8867 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8868
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008869 Supported in default-server: No
8870
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008871verify [none|required]
8872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01008873 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
8874 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
8875 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
8876 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008877 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8878 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8879 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008880
8881 Supported in default-server: No
8882
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008883verifyhost <hostname>
8884 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8885 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8886 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8887 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8888 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8889 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8890
8891 Supported in default-server: No
8892
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008893weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008894 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8895 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8896 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008897 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8898 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8899 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8900 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8901 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8902 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008903
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008904 Supported in default-server: Yes
8905
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008906
89076. HTTP header manipulation
8908---------------------------
8909
8910In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8911response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8912request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8913which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008914against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008915
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008916If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
8917to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
8918but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
8919HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
8920stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
8921because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
8922a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
8923still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008924
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008925This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8926in section 4.2 :
8927
8928 - reqadd <string>
8929 - reqallow <search>
8930 - reqiallow <search>
8931 - reqdel <search>
8932 - reqidel <search>
8933 - reqdeny <search>
8934 - reqideny <search>
8935 - reqpass <search>
8936 - reqipass <search>
8937 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8938 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8939 - reqtarpit <search>
8940 - reqitarpit <search>
8941 - rspadd <string>
8942 - rspdel <search>
8943 - rspidel <search>
8944 - rspdeny <search>
8945 - rspideny <search>
8946 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8947 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8948
8949With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8950is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8951parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8952prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8953Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8954
8955 \t for a tab
8956 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8957 \n for a new line (LF)
8958 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8959 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8960 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8961 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8962 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8963
8964The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8965portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8966above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8967regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
89689 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8969is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8970
8971The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8972after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8973
8974Notes related to these keywords :
8975---------------------------------
8976 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8977 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8978 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8979
8980 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8981 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8982 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8983
8984 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8985 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8986 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8987 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8988 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8989
8990 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8991 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8992 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8993 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8994 useless headers before adding new ones.
8995
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008996 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008997 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8998
8999 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9000 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9001 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9002
9003 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9004 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009005 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009006
9007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020090087. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9009----------------------------------
9010
9011Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9012client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9013The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9014these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9015but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9016data called patterns.
9017
9018
90197.1. ACL basics
9020---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009021
9022The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9023content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9024from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9025simple :
9026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009027 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009028 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009029 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9030 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009032The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9033adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009034
9035In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009037 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009038
9039This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9040Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9041and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009042an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9043conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9044as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9045are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009046
9047ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9048'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9049which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9050
9051There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9052performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009054The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9055specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9056this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009057methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9058ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009059
9060Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9061 - boolean
9062 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9063 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9064 - string
9065 - data block
9066
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009067Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9068converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9069would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9070The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9071which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009073The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9074 - boolean
9075 - integer or integer range
9076 - IP address / network
9077 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9078 - regular expression
9079 - hex block
9080
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009081The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9082
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009083 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9084 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009085 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009086 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009087 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009088 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009089 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009091The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9092read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9093if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9094lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9095will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9096beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9097a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9098lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9099exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9100
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009101The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9102parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9103ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9104a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9105check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9106
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009107The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9108socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9109file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009111Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9112loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9113
9114 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9115
9116In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9117the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9118case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9119as well.
9120
9121The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9122sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9123do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9124methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9125is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9126obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9127followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9128default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9129that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9130string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9131
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009132The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9133By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9134string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9135resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9136server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9137waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9138flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9139function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009141There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9142sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9143be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009144
9145 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9146 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009147 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9148 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9149 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9150 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009151
9152 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9153 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009154 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009155
9156 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009157 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009158
9159 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009160 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009161
9162 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9163 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9164
9165 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9166 binary or string samples.
9167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009168 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9169 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009171 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9172 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9173 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009175 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9176 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009178 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9179 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009181 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9182 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009184 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9185 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009186 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009188 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9189 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9190 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009191
9192For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9193request, it is possible to do :
9194
9195 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9196
9197In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9198buffer, one would use the following acl :
9199
9200 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9201
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009202On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9203possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9204
9205 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009207All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9208criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9209method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9210to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9211criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9212the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009214If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009215the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9216For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009218 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9219 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9220 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9221 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009222
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009223
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009224The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample types
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009225and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9226combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
9227the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009229 +-------------------------------------------------+
9230 | Input sample type |
9231 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9232 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
9233 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9234 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9235 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009236 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009237 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009238 | integer (value) | int | *int | int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009239 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009240 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009241 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009242 | IP address | | | *ip | ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009243 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009244 | exact string | str | str | str | str | str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009245 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009246 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009247 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009248 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009249 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009250 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009251 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009252 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009253 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009254 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009255 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009256 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009257 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9258 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9259 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009260
9261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020092627.1.1. Matching booleans
9263------------------------
9264
9265In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9266Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9267When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9268that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9269
9270Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9271return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9272"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9273
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020092757.1.2. Matching integers
9276------------------------
9277
9278Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9279enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9280to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9281
9282Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9283matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9284lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009285
9286For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9287unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9288representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9289
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009290As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9291two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9292instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9293ranges and operators.
9294
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009295For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009296operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9297Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9298of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009299
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009300Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009301
9302 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9303 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9304 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9305 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9306 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9307
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009308For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009309
9310 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9311
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009312This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9313
9314 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9315
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093177.1.3. Matching strings
9318-----------------------
9319
9320String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9321different forms :
9322
9323 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9324 patterns ;
9325
9326 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9327 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9328
9329 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9330 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9331
9332 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9333 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9334
9335 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9336 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9337 matches.
9338
9339 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9340 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9341 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009342
9343String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9344exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9345characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9346string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9347to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009348before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009349
9350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093517.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9352---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009353
9354Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9355they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9356possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9357passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9358the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009359the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9360match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009361
9362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093637.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9364-------------------------------------
9365
9366It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9367not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9368a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9369to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9370digits may be used upper or lower case.
9371
9372Example :
9373 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9374 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9375
9376
93777.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9378---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009379
9380IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9381netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9382within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009383host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009384difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9385at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9386does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9387parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009388
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009389IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9390Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9391trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9392IPv6 patterns.
9393
9394HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9395following situations :
9396 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9397 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9398 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9399 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9400 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9401 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9402 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9403 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9404 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9405 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009407
94087.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9409----------------------------------
9410
9411Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9412combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9413
9414 - AND (implicit)
9415 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9416 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009418A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009420 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009422Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9423indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009425For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9426"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9427requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9428is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9429
9430 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9431 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9432 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9433 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9434
9435To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9436and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9437
9438 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9439 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9440 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9441 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9442
9443 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9444 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9445 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9446 use_backend www if host_www
9447
9448It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9449expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9450be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9451the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9452
9453 The following rule :
9454
9455 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9456 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9457
9458 Can also be written that way :
9459
9460 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9461
9462It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9463to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9464simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9465sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9466good use is the following :
9467
9468 With named ACLs :
9469
9470 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9471 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9472 monitor fail if site_dead
9473
9474 With anonymous ACLs :
9475
9476 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9477
9478See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9479
9480
94817.3. Fetching samples
9482---------------------
9483
9484Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9485against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9486sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9487ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9488of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9489available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9490
9491This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9492Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9493compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9494deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9495
9496The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9497matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9498method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9499indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9500
9501As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9502when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9503mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9504the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9505ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9506
9507Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9508multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9509when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9510incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9511are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9512is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9513all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9514
9515Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9516 - name
9517 - name(arg1)
9518 - name(arg1,arg2)
9519
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009520
95217.3.1. Converters
9522-----------------
9523
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009524Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9525of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9526is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9527was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9528has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9529unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9530
9531These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9532sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9533the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9534support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009536The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009537
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009538base64
9539 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9540 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9541 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9542
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009543lower
9544 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9545 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9546 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009547
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009548upper
9549 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
9550 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9551 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009552
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009553hex
9554 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9555 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9556 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9557 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009558
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009559ipmask(<mask>)
9560 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9561 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9562 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9563 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009564
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009565http_date([<offset>])
9566 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9567 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9568 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9569 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9570 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9571 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009572
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009573language(<value>[,<default>])
9574 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9575 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9576 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9577 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9578 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9579 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9580 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9581 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9582 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9583 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9584 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9585 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009586
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009587 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009588
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009589 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9590 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009591
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009592 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9593 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9594 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9595 use_backend spanish if es
9596 use_backend french if fr
9597 use_backend english if en
9598 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009599
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009600map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9601map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9602map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9603 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9604 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
9605 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
9606 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
9607 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
9608 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
9609 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
9610 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009611
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009612 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
9613 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
9614 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009615
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009616 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
9617 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009618
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009619 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
9620 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9621 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
9622 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9623 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
9624 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9625 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
9626 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9627 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
9628 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9629 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
9630 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9631 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
9632 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9633 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
9634 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9635 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
9636 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009637
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009638 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
9639 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
9640 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
9641 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9642 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009643
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009644 Example :
9645
9646 # this is a comment and is ignored
9647 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9648 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9649 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9650 | | | `---------- value
9651 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
9652 | `---------------------------- key
9653 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9654
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009655
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020096567.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009657--------------------------------------------
9658
9659A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9660not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9661"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9662The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9663
9664always_false : boolean
9665 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9666 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9667
9668always_true : boolean
9669 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9670 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9671
9672avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009673 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009674 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9675 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9676 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9677 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9678 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9679 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9680 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9681 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9682 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9683 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9684 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9685 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9686 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009688be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009689 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9690 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9691 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9692 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9693 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009695be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9696 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9697 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9698 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9699 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9700 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9701 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009702
9703 Example :
9704 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9705 backend dynamic
9706 mode http
9707 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9708 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009710connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9711 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009712 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009713 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9714 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009715
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009716 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009717 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009718 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9719
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009720 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9721 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009722
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009723 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009724 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009725 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009726 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9727 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009728 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009729 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009730
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009731 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9732 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009733 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009734 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009735
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009736date([<offset>]) : integer
9737 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9738 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9739 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9740 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009741 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9742
9743 Example :
9744
9745 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9746 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009747
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009748env(<name>) : string
9749 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9750 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9751 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9752 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9753 certain way.
9754
9755 Examples :
9756 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9757 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9758
9759 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9760 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009762fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9763 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009764 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9765 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009766 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9767 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9768 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9769 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9770 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009772fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9773 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9774 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9775 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9776 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9777 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9778 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9779 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9780 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009781
9782 Example :
9783 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9784 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9785 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9786 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9787 frontend mail
9788 bind :25
9789 mode tcp
9790 maxconn 100
9791 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9792 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9793 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9794 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009796nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9797 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9798 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9799 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009800 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9801 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9802 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009804queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009805 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9806 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9807 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009808 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9809 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9810 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9811 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9812 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9813
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +01009814rand([<range>]) : integer
9815 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
9816 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
9817 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
9818 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
9819 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
9820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009821srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9822 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9823 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9824 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9825 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9826 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9827 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9828 methods.
9829
9830srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9831 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9832 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9833 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9834 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
9835 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
9836 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
9837 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
9838
9839srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9840 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9841 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009842 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009843 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
9844 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
9845 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
9846 overloading servers).
9847
9848 Example :
9849 # Redirect to a separate back
9850 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
9851 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
9852 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
9853
9854table_avl([<table>]) : integer
9855 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
9856 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
9857
9858table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9859 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9860 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9861 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9862
9863
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020098647.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009865----------------------------------
9866
9867The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9868closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9869methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9870sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9871TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009872the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9873counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9874"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009875argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9876the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9877this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009878
9879be_id : integer
9880 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9881 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9882
9883dst : ip
9884 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9885 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9886 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9887 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9888 RFC 4291.
9889
9890dst_conn : integer
9891 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9892 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9893 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9894 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9895 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9896 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9897 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9898 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009900dst_port : integer
9901 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9902 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9903 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9904 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9905 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9906 an HTTP header.
9907
9908fe_id : integer
9909 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9910 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9911 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9912
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009913sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009914sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9915sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9916sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009917 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9918 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9919 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9920
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009921sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009922sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9923sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9924sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009925 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9926 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9927 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9928
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009929sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009930sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9931sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9932sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009933 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9934 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009935 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9936 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9937 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009938
9939 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9940 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009941 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9942 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9943 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009944 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9945 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9946
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009947sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009948sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9949sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9950sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009951 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9952 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9953
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009954sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009955sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9956sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9957sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009958 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9959 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9960 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9961
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009962sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009963sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9964sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9965sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009966 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9967 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9968 See also src_conn_rate.
9969
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009970sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009971sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9972sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9973sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009974 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009975 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009976
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009977sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009978sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9979sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9980sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009981 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9982 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9983 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009984 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9985 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9986 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009987
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009988sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009989sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9990sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9991sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009992 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9993 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9994 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9995
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009996sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009997sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9998sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9999sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010000 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10001 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10002 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10003 src_http_err_rate.
10004
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010005sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010006sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10007sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10008sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010009 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10010 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10011 src_http_req_cnt.
10012
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010013sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010014sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10015sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10016sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010017 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10018 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10019 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10020 src_http_req_rate.
10021
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010022sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010023sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10024sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10025sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010026 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010027 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10028 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10029 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10030 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010031
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010032 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10033 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010034 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10035
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010036sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010037sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10038sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10039sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010040 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10041 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10042 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10043 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
10044
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010045sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010046sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10047sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10048sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010049 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10050 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10051 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10052 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
10053
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010054sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010055sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10056sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10057sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010058 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10059 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10060 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10061 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010062 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010063 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10064
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010065sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010066sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10067sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10068sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010069 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10070 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10071 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10072 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10073 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010074 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010075
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010076sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010077sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10078sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10079sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010080 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10081 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10082 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10083
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010084sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010085sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10086sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10087sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010088 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10089 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010090 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010091 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10092 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010093 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10094 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10095 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010097so_id : integer
10098 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10099 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10100 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010102src : ip
10103 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10104 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10105 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10106 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10107 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10108 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10109 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010110
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010111 Example:
10112 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10113 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010115src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10116 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10117 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10118 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010119 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010121src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10122 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10123 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010124 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010125 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010127src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10128 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10129 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10130 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10131 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10132 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10133 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010134
10135 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10136 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10137 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10138 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010139 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010140 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10141 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010143src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010144 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010145 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010146 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010147 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010149src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010150 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010151 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10152 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010153 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010155src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10156 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10157 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10158 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010159 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010161src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010162 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010163 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010164 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010165 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010167src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010168 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010169 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010170 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10171 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010172 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10173 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10174 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010176src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10177 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10178 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010179 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010180 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010181 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010183src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10184 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10185 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10186 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10187 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010188 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010190src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10191 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10192 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10193 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010194 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010196src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10197 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10198 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10199 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010200 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010201 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010203src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10204 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10205 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10206 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010207 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010208 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10209 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010210
10211 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010212 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010213 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010215src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10216 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
10217 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10218 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
10219 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010220 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
10221 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010223src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10224 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
10225 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010226 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
10227 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010228 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010230src_port : integer
10231 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10232 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10233 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10234 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010236src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10237 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010238 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10239 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10240 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010241 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010243src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10244 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10245 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10246 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10247 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010248 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010250src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10251 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10252 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10253 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10254 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10255 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10256 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10257 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10258 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010259
10260 Example :
10261 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10262 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10263 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10264 listen ssh
10265 bind :22
10266 mode tcp
10267 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010268 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010269 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010270 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010272srv_id : integer
10273 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10274 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10275 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010276
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010277
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200102787.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010279----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010281The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10282closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10283when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10284usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010285future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010286
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010287ssl_bc : boolean
10288 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10289 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10290 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10291
10292ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10293 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10294 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10295
10296ssl_bc_cipher : string
10297 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10298 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10299
10300ssl_bc_protocol : string
10301 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10302 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10303
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010304ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010305 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010306 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10307 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010308
10309ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10310 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10311 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10312 if session was reused or not.
10313
10314ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10315 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10316 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010318ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10319 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10320 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10321 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10322 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10323 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010325ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10326 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10327 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10328 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10329 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010331ssl_c_err : integer
10332 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10333 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10334 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10335 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10336 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010338ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10339 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10340 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10341 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10342 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10343 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10344 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10345 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10346 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010348ssl_c_key_alg : string
10349 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10350 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10351 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010353ssl_c_notafter : string
10354 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10355 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10356 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010358ssl_c_notbefore : string
10359 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10360 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10361 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010363ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10364 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10365 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10366 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10367 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10368 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10369 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10370 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10371 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010373ssl_c_serial : binary
10374 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10375 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10376 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010378ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10379 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10380 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10381 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010383ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10384 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10385 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10386 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010388ssl_c_used : boolean
10389 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10390 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010392ssl_c_verify : integer
10393 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10394 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10395 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10396 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010398ssl_c_version : integer
10399 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10400 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010402ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10403 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10404 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10405 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10406 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010407 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010408 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10409 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10410 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010412ssl_f_key_alg : string
10413 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10414 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10415 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010417ssl_f_notafter : string
10418 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10419 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10420 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010422ssl_f_notbefore : string
10423 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10424 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10425 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010427ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10428 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10429 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10430 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10431 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10432 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10433 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10434 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10435 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010437ssl_f_serial : binary
10438 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10439 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10440 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010441
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010442ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10443 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10444 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10445 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010447ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10448 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10449 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10450 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010452ssl_f_version : integer
10453 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10454 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10455
10456ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010457 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10458 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10459 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010461 Example :
10462 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10463 listen http-https
10464 bind :80
10465 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10466 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10467
10468ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10469 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10470 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10471
10472ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010473 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010474 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10475 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10476 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10477 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10478 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10479 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10480 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10481 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010483ssl_fc_cipher : string
10484 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10485 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010487ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010488 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10489 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010490 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10491 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10492 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10493 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010495ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10496 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010497 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10498 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10499 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10500 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010502ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010503 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010504 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10505 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10506 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10507 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10508 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10509 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10510 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010512ssl_fc_protocol : string
10513 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10514 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010515
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010516ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010517 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010518 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10519 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010521ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10522 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10523 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10524 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10525 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010527ssl_fc_sni : string
10528 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10529 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10530 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10531 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10532 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10533
10534 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10535 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10536 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010537 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10538 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010540 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010541 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10542 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010544ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10545 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10546 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010547
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010548
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200105497.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010550------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010552Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10553sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10554only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10555For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10556be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10557can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10558sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10559for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10560content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010562payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10563 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10564 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10565 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010567payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10568 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10569 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10570 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010572req.len : integer
10573req_len : integer (deprecated)
10574 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10575 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10576 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10577 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10578 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10579 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10580 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10581 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010583req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10584 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010585 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10586 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10587 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10588 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010590 ACL alternatives :
10591 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010593req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10594 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10595 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10596 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10597 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010599 ACL alternatives :
10600 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010602 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010604req.proto_http : boolean
10605req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10606 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10607 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10608 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10609 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10610 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10611 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10612 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010614 Example:
10615 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10616 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10617 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010618 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010620req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10621rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10622 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10623 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10624 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10625 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10626 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10627 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10628 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010630 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10631 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10632 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10633 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10634 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10635 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010637 ACL derivatives :
10638 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010640 Example :
10641 listen tse-farm
10642 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10643 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10644 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10645 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10646 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10647 persist rdp-cookie
10648 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10649 # This is only useful makes sense if
10650 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10651 stick-table type string size 204800
10652 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10653 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10654 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010656 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10657 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010659req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10660rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10661 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10662 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10663 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10664 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010666 ACL derivatives :
10667 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010669req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10670req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10671 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10672 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10673 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10674 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10675 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10676 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10677 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010679req.ssl_sni : string
10680req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10681 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10682 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10683 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10684 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10685 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10686 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10687 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10688 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10689 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10690 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10691 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10692 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010694 ACL derivatives :
10695 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010697 Examples :
10698 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10699 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10700 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10701 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10702 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010704res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10705rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10706 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10707 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10708 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10709 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10710 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10711 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10712 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010714req.ssl_ver : integer
10715req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10716 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10717 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10718 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10719 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10720 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10721 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10722 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10723 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10724 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010726 ACL derivatives :
10727 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010728
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010729res.len : integer
10730 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10731 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10732 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10733 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10734 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10735 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10736 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10737 content inspection.
10738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010739res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10740 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010741 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10742 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10743 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10744 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010746res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10747 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10748 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10749 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10750 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010752 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010754wait_end : boolean
10755 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10756 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10757 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10758 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10759 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10760 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10761 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10762 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010764 Examples :
10765 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10766 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10767 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010769 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10770 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10771 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10772 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10773 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10774 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10775 tcp-request content reject
10776
10777
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200107787.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010779--------------------------------------
10780
10781It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10782This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10783data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10784its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10785HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10786content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10787to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10788more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10789response are indexed.
10790
10791base : string
10792 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10793 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10794 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10795 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10796 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10797 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10798 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10799 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10800
10801 ACL derivatives :
10802 base : exact string match
10803 base_beg : prefix match
10804 base_dir : subdir match
10805 base_dom : domain match
10806 base_end : suffix match
10807 base_len : length match
10808 base_reg : regex match
10809 base_sub : substring match
10810
10811base32 : integer
10812 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10813 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10814 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10815 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10816
10817base32+src : binary
10818 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10819 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10820 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10821 per-URL counters.
10822
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010010823capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
10824 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
10825 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10826 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
10827
10828capture.req.method : string
10829 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
10830 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
10831 because it's allocated.
10832
10833capture.req.uri : string
10834 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
10835 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
10836 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
10837 allocated.
10838
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020010839capture.req.ver : string
10840 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
10841 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
10842 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
10843
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010010844capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
10845 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
10846 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10847 The first entry is an index of 0.
10848 See also: "capture response header"
10849
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020010850capture.res.ver : string
10851 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
10852 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
10853 persistent flag.
10854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010855req.cook([<name>]) : string
10856cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10857 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10858 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10859 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
10860 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
10861 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
10862 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
10863 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
10864 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
10865
10866 ACL derivatives :
10867 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
10868 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
10869 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
10870 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
10871 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
10872 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
10873 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
10874 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010876req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10877cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10878 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10879 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010881req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10882cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10883 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10884 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
10885 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
10886 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010888cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10889 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10890 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10891 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10892 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10893 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10894 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10895 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10896 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10897 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10898 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010900hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10901 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10902 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10903 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10904 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010905 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010907req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10908 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10909 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10910 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10911 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10912 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10913 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10914 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10915 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010917req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10918 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10919 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10920 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10921 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010923req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10924 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10925 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10926 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10927 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10928 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10929 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10930 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10931 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10932 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10933 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10934 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010936 ACL derivatives :
10937 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10938 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10939 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10940 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10941 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10942 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10943 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10944 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10945
10946req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10947hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10948 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10949 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10950 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10951 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10952 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10953 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10954 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10955 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10956 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10957
10958req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10959hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10960 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10961 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10962 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10963 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10964 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10965 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10966 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10967 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10968
10969req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10970hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10971 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10972 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10973 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10974 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10975 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10976 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10977 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10978
10979http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10980 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10981 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10982 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10983 basic auth is supported.
10984
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010010985http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
10986 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
10987 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
10988 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
10989 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010990 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10991 basic auth is supported.
10992
10993 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010010994 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
10995 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
10996 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
10997 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010998
10999http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011000 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11001 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011002 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11003 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011005method : integer + string
11006 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11007 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11008 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11009 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11010 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11011 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11012 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011014 ACL derivatives :
11015 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011017 Example :
11018 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11019 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11020 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011022path : string
11023 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11024 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11025 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11026 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11027 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11028 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11029 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011031 ACL derivatives :
11032 path : exact string match
11033 path_beg : prefix match
11034 path_dir : subdir match
11035 path_dom : domain match
11036 path_end : suffix match
11037 path_len : length match
11038 path_reg : regex match
11039 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011041req.ver : string
11042req_ver : string (deprecated)
11043 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11044 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11045 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011047 ACL derivatives :
11048 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011050res.comp : boolean
11051 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11052 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11053 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011055res.comp_algo : string
11056 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11057 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11058 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011060res.cook([<name>]) : string
11061scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11062 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11063 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11064 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011066 ACL derivatives :
11067 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011069res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11070scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11071 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11072 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11073 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011075res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11076scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11077 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11078 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11079 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011081res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11082 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11083 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11084 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11085 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11086 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11087 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11088 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11089 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11090 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011092res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11093 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11094 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11095 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11096 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11097 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011099res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11100shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11101 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11102 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11103 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11104 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11105 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11106 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11107 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11108 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011110 ACL derivatives :
11111 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11112 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11113 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11114 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11115 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11116 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11117 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11118 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11119
11120res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11121shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11122 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11123 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11124 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11125 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11126 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011128res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11129shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11130 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11131 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11132 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11133 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11134 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11135 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011137res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11138shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11139 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11140 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11141 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11142 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11143 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11144 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011146res.ver : string
11147resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11148 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11149 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011151 ACL derivatives :
11152 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011154set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11155 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11156 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11157 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11158 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011160 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11161 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011163 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011165status : integer
11166 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11167 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11168 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011170url : string
11171 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11172 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11173 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11174 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11175 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11176 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11177 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011179 ACL derivatives :
11180 url : exact string match
11181 url_beg : prefix match
11182 url_dir : subdir match
11183 url_dom : domain match
11184 url_end : suffix match
11185 url_len : length match
11186 url_reg : regex match
11187 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011189url_ip : ip
11190 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11191 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11192 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11193 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11194 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11195 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11196 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011198url_port : integer
11199 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11200 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11201 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11202 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011204urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11205url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11206 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11207 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11208 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11209 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11210 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11211 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11212 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11213 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11214 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011216 ACL derivatives :
11217 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11218 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11219 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11220 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11221 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11222 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11223 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11224 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011225
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011227 Example :
11228 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11229 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11230 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11231 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011233urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11234 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11235 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11236 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011237
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200112397.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011240---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011242Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11243every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011244order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011245
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011246ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11247---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011248FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011249HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011250HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11251HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011252HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11253HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11254HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11255HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11256LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011257METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11258METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11259METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11260METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11261METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11262METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011263RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011264REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011265TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011266WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11267---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011268
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112708. Logging
11271----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011272
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011273One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11274provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11275very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11276provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11277state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011278to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011279headers.
11280
11281In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11282about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11283send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11284
11285 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11286 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11287 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11288 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11289 at the termination.
11290
11291The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11292allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11293as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11294while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11295real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11296delay.
11297
11298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112998.1. Log levels
11300---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011301
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011302TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011303source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011304HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11305in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11306track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11307syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11308about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011309
11310
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200113118.2. Log formats
11312----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011313
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011314HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011315and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11316slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11317options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011318
11319 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11320 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11321 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11322 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11323 extents.
11324
11325 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11326 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11327 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11328 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11329 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11330
11331 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11332 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11333 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11334 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11335 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11336
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011337 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11338 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11339 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11340 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11341
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011342 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11343
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011344Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11345specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11346field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11347servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11348always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11349identifier.
11350
11351Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11352 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11353 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11354 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11355 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11356
11357
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200113588.2.1. Default log format
11359-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011360
11361This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11362as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11363format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11364
11365 Example :
11366 listen www
11367 mode http
11368 log global
11369 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11370
11371 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11372 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11373 (www/HTTP)
11374
11375 Field Format Extract from the example above
11376 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11377 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11378 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11379 4 'to' to
11380 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11381 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11382
11383Detailed fields description :
11384 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11385 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11386 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11387 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11388 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11389 and processed the connection.
11390 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11391
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011392In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11393"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11394connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11395
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011396It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11397will eventually disappear.
11398
11399
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114008.2.2. TCP log format
11401---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011402
11403The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11404is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11405information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11406counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11407emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11408environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11409the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11410sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011411specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11412not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11413fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11414marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011415
11416 Example :
11417 frontend fnt
11418 mode tcp
11419 option tcplog
11420 log global
11421 default_backend bck
11422
11423 backend bck
11424 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11425
11426 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11427 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11428 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11429
11430 Field Format Extract from the example above
11431 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11432 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11433 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11434 4 frontend_name fnt
11435 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11436 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11437 7 bytes_read* 212
11438 8 termination_state --
11439 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11440 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11441
11442Detailed fields description :
11443 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011444 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11445 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11446 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11447 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11448 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011449
11450 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011451 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11452 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11453 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011454
11455 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11456 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11457 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11458 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11459
11460 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11461 and processed the connection.
11462
11463 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11464 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11465 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11466 applications.
11467
11468 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11469 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11470 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11471 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11472 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11473
11474 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11475 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11476 See "Timers" below for more details.
11477
11478 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11479 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11480 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11481 "Timers" below for more details.
11482
11483 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011484 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011485 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11486 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11487 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11488 details.
11489
11490 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11491 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11492 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11493 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11494 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11495
11496 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11497 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11498 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11499 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11500 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11501 for more details.
11502
11503 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011504 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011505 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11506 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11507 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011508 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011509
11510 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11511 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11512 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11513 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11514 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11515 caused by a denial of service attack.
11516
11517 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11518 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11519 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11520 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11521 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11522 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11523 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11524 denial of service attack.
11525
11526 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11527 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11528 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11529 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11530 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11531 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11532 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11533 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11534 be processed than on other servers.
11535
11536 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11537 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11538 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11539 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11540 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11541 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11542 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11543 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11544 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11545 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11546 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11547 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11548 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11549
11550 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11551 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11552 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11553 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11554 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11555 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11556 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11557 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11558
11559 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11560 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11561 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11562 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11563 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11564 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11565 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11566 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11567 occurs.
11568
11569
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115708.2.3. HTTP log format
11571----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011572
11573The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11574is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11575the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11576are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11577emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11578generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11579"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11580which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011581frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11582is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011583
11584Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11585slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11586with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11587
11588 Example :
11589 frontend http-in
11590 mode http
11591 option httplog
11592 log global
11593 default_backend bck
11594
11595 backend static
11596 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11597
11598 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11599 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11600 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011601 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011602
11603 Field Format Extract from the example above
11604 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11605 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11606 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11607 4 frontend_name http-in
11608 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11609 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11610 7 status_code 200
11611 8 bytes_read* 2750
11612 9 captured_request_cookie -
11613 10 captured_response_cookie -
11614 11 termination_state ----
11615 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11616 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11617 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11618 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11619 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011620
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011621
11622Detailed fields description :
11623 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011624 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11625 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11626 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11627 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11628 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011629
11630 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011631 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11632 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11633 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011634
11635 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11636 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11637 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11638 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11639 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11640
11641 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11642 and processed the connection.
11643
11644 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11645 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11646 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11647
11648 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11649 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11650 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11651 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11652 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11653 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11654
11655 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11656 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11657 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11658 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11659 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11660 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11661
11662 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11663 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11664 See "Timers" below for more details.
11665
11666 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11667 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11668 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11669 below for more details.
11670
11671 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11672 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11673 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11674 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11675 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11676 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11677 for more details.
11678
11679 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011680 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011681 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11682 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11683 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11684 details.
11685
11686 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11687 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11688 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11689
11690 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11691 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11692 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11693 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11694 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11695 overflowing.
11696
11697 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11698 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11699 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11700 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11701 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11702 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11703 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11704 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11705
11706 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11707 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11708 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11709 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11710 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11711 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11712 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11713 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11714
11715 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11716 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11717 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11718 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11719 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11720 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11721 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11722
11723 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011724 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011725 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11726 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11727 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011728 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011729 system.
11730
11731 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11732 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11733 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11734 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11735 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11736 caused by a denial of service attack.
11737
11738 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11739 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11740 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11741 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11742 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11743 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11744 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11745 denial of service attack.
11746
11747 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11748 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11749 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11750 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11751 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11752 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11753 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11754 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11755 processed than on other servers.
11756
11757 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11758 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11759 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11760 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11761 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11762 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11763 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11764 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11765 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11766 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11767 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11768 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11769 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11770
11771 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11772 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11773 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11774 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11775 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11776 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11777 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11778 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11779
11780 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11781 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11782 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11783 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11784 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11785 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11786 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11787 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11788 occurs.
11789
11790 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11791 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11792 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11793 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11794 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11795 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11796 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11797 cookies" below for more details.
11798
11799 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11800 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11801 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11802 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11803 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11804 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11805 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11806 and cookies" below for more details.
11807
11808 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11809 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11810 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11811 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11812 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11813 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11814 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11815 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11816
11817
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200118188.2.4. Custom log format
11819------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011820
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011821The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011822mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011823
11824HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11825Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11826separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11827prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11828
11829Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11830variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11831string formats ("Q").
11832
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011833If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011834as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011835less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
11836the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
11837
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011838Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011839In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010011840in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011841
11842Flags are :
11843 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011844 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011845
11846 Example:
11847
11848 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
11849 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
11850
11851At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
11852
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011853 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
11854 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011855
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011856the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011857
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011858 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011859 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011860 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011861
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011862and the default TCP format is defined this way :
11863
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011864 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011865 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
11866
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011867Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
11868
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011869 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011870 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011871 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
11872 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
11873 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011874 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
11875 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
11876 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011877 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011878 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011879 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011880 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011881 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080011882 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011883 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
11884 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011885 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011886 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
11887 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011888 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011889 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
11890 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011891 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11892 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
11893 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011894 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011895 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11896 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011897 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011898 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11899 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11900 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011901 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011902 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11903 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11904 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11905 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011906 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011907 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011908 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011909 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010011910 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011911 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011912 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11913 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11914 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011915 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011916 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11917 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011918 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011919 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011920 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011921 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011922
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011923 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011924
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011925
119268.2.5. Error log format
11927-----------------------
11928
11929When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11930protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11931By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11932"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11933will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11934logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11935
11936The format looks like this :
11937
11938 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11939 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11940 Connection error during SSL handshake
11941
11942 Field Format Extract from the example above
11943 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11944 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11945 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11946 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11947 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11948
11949These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11950failures.
11951
11952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119538.3. Advanced logging options
11954-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011955
11956Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11957just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11958options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11959for more information about their usage.
11960
11961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119628.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11963------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011964
11965It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11966haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11967commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11968monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11969ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11970
11971 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11972 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11973 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11974 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11975
11976 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11977 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11978 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011979 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011980 such as other load-balancers.
11981
11982 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11983 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11984 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11985
11986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119878.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11988----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011989
11990The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11991what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11992or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11993"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11994just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11995log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11996after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11997is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11998with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11999with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12000
12001
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120028.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12003------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012004
12005Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12006for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12007"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12008retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12009raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12010a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12011file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12012you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12013"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12014
12015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120168.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12017--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012018
12019Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12020multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12021them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12022"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12023logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12024error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12025and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12026too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12027useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12028alternative.
12029
12030
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120318.4. Timing events
12032------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012033
12034Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12035reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12036the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12037frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12038mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12039
12040 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12041 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12042 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12043 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12044 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12045
12046 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12047 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12048 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12049 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12050 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12051
12052 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12053 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12054 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12055 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12056 connection never established.
12057
12058 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12059 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12060 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12061 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12062 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12063 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12064 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12065 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12066 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12067 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12068 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12069
12070 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12071 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12072 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12073 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012074 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012075
12076 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12077
12078 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12079 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12080 negative.
12081
12082These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12083protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12084that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012085due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012086close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12087session has been aborted on timeout.
12088
12089Most common cases :
12090
12091 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12092 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12093 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12094 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12095 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12096 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12097 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12098 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12099 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012100 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12101 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12102 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012103
12104 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12105 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12106 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12107 of ms on remote networks.
12108
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012109 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12110 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12111 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012112
12113 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12114 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12115 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12116 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12117 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12118 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12119 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12120 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12121 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12122 to the server until another one is released.
12123
12124Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12125
12126 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12127 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12128 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12129
12130 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12131 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12132 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12133
12134 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12135 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12136 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12137 flags.
12138
12139 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12140 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12141 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12142 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12143 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12144 the client connection was maintained open.
12145
12146 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012147 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012148 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12149 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12150
12151
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121528.5. Session state at disconnection
12153-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012154
12155TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12156"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
121572-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12158each of which has a special meaning :
12159
12160 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12161 session to terminate :
12162
12163 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12164
12165 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12166 server explicitly refused it.
12167
12168 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12169 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12170 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12171 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012172 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12173
12174 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12175 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012176
12177 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12178 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12179 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12180 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12181 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12182
12183 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12184 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12185 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12186 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12187 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12188
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012189 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12190 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12191
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012192 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12193 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12194 backup connections when going up.
12195
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012196 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12197
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012198 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12199 send or receive data.
12200
12201 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12202 send or receive data.
12203
12204 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12205 with nothing left in the buffers.
12206
12207 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12208
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012209 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012210 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12211
12212 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12213 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12214 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12215 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12216 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12217
12218 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12219 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12220
12221 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12222 server (HTTP only).
12223
12224 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12225
12226 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12227 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12228 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12229
12230 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12231 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12232 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12233
12234 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12235
12236 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12237 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12238
12239 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12240 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12241 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12242
12243 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12244 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012245 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12246 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012247
12248 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12249 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12250 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12251 another server.
12252
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012253 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012254 server.
12255
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012256 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12257 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12258 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12259 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12260
12261 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12262 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12263 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12264 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12265
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012266 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12267 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12268 "use-server" rule).
12269
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012270 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12271
12272 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12273 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12274
12275 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12276
12277 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12278 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12279 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12280
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012281 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12282 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012283 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012284 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12285 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12286
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012287 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12288
12289 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12290 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12291
12292 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12293
12294 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12295
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012296The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12297was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012298helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12299starvation, attacks, etc...
12300
12301The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12302alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12303easier finding and understanding.
12304
12305 Flags Reason
12306
12307 -- Normal termination.
12308
12309 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12310 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12311 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12312 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12313
12314 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12315 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12316 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12317 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12318 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12319 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012320
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012321 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12322 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012323 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012324
12325 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12326 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12327 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12328
12329 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12330 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12331 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12332 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12333 the server takes too long to respond.
12334
12335 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12336 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12337 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12338 long a time to respond.
12339
12340 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12341 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12342 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12343 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12344 and the client.
12345
12346 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12347 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12348 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12349 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12350 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
12351 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
12352
12353 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12354 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012355 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12356 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12357 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12358 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012359
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012360 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12361 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012363 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012364 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12365 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12366 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12367 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12368 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12369
12370 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12371 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12372 503 or 504 here.
12373
12374 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12375 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12376 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12377 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12378 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12379
12380 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12381 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012382 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012383 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12384 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12385
12386 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12387 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12388 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12389 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12390 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12391 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12392 between haproxy and the server.
12393
12394 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12395 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12396 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12397 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12398 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12399 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12400 solution is to fix the application.
12401
12402 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12403 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12404 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12405 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12406 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12407 external attacks.
12408
12409 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12410 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012411 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012412 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12413 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12414
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012415 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12416 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12417 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012418 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12419 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012420
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012421 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12422 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12423 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12424 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012425 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12426 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12427 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12428 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12429 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012430
12431 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12432 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12433 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12434 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12435
12436 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12437 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12438 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12439 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12440
12441 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12442 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12443 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12444 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12445
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012446The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12447persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12448important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12449re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12450
12451 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12452
12453 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12454 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12455 set on a GET request.
12456
12457 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12458 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012459 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012460 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12461
12462 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12463 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12464 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12465
12466 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12467 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12468 already got a cookie.
12469
12470 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12471 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12472 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12473 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12474 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12475
12476 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12477 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12478 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12479
12480 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12481 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12482 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12483
12484 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12485 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12486
12487 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12488 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12489 then advertised in the response.
12490
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124928.6. Non-printable characters
12493-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012494
12495In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12496consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12497converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12498prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12499being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12500escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12501is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12502'}' when logging headers.
12503
12504Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12505issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12506containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12507
12508Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12509the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12510performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12511
12512
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125138.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12514---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012515
12516Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12517achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012518section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012519cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12520the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12521the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012522locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012523not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12524user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12525a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12526wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12527
12528 Examples :
12529 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12530 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12531
12532 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12533 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12534
12535
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125368.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12537---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012538
12539Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12540proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12541the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12542server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12543
12544Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12545response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012546section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012547
12548It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012549time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12550appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012551are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12552and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12553follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12554request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12555in the logs.
12556
12557 Example :
12558 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12559 listen proxy-out
12560 mode http
12561 option httplog
12562 option logasap
12563 log global
12564 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12565
12566 # log the name of the virtual server
12567 capture request header Host len 20
12568
12569 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12570 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12571
12572 # log the beginning of the referrer
12573 capture request header Referer len 20
12574
12575 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12576 capture response header Server len 20
12577
12578 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12579 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12580
12581 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12582 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12583
12584 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12585 capture response header Via len 20
12586
12587 # log the URL location during a redirection
12588 capture response header Location len 20
12589
12590 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12591 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12592 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12593 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12594 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12595
12596 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12597 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12598 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12599 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012600 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012601
12602 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12603 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12604 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12605 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12606 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012607 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012608
12609
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126108.9. Examples of logs
12611---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012612
12613These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12614them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12615reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12616
12617 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12618 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12619 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12620
12621 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12622 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12623
12624 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12625 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12626 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12627
12628 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12629 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12630
12631 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12632 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12633 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12634
12635 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012636 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012637 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12638 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12639
12640 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12641 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12642 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12643
12644 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12645 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012646 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012647 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12648 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12649 to return the 502 and not the server.
12650
12651 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012652 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012653
12654 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12655 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12656 Nothing was sent to any server.
12657
12658 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12659 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12660
12661 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12662 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12663 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12664 send a 408 return code to the client.
12665
12666 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12667 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12668
12669 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12670 5 seconds ("c----").
12671
12672 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12673 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012674 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012675
12676 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012677 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012678 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12679 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12680 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12681 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12682 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012683
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012684
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126859. Statistics and monitoring
12686----------------------------
12687
12688It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12689mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12690CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12691Unix socket.
12692
12693
126949.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012695---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012696
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012697The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12698page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12699
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012700 0. pxname: proxy name
12701 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12702 for server)
12703 2. qcur: current queued requests
12704 3. qmax: max queued requests
12705 4. scur: current sessions
12706 5. smax: max sessions
12707 6. slim: sessions limit
12708 7. stot: total sessions
12709 8. bin: bytes in
12710 9. bout: bytes out
12711 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012712 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012713 12. ereq: request errors
12714 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012715 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012716 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12717 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012718 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012719 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12720 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12721 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12722 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12723 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12724 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12725 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12726 25. qlimit: queue limit
12727 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12728 27. iid: unique proxy id
12729 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12730 29. throttle: warm up status
12731 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12732 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012733 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012734 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12735 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12736 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012737 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012738 UNK -> unknown
12739 INI -> initializing
12740 SOCKERR -> socket error
12741 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12742 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12743 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12744 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12745 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12746 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12747 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12748 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12749 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12750 disable-on-404
12751 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12752 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12753 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012754 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12755 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012756 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12757 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12758 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12759 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12760 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12761 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012762 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12763 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12764 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12765 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012766 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12767 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012768 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12769 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12770 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012771 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreauf522f3d2014-02-10 22:22:49 +010012772 55. lastsess: number of seconds since last session assigned to server/backend
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012773
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012774
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127759.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012776-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012777
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012778The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12779necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12780A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12781issuing commands by hand :
12782
12783 global
12784 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12785 stats timeout 2m
12786
12787It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12788the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12789never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12790situations :
12791
12792 global
12793 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12794 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12795 stats timeout 2m
12796
12797To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12798swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12799to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12800syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12801
12802 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12803 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12804
12805The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12806script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12807for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12808
12809The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12810that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12811editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12812(eg: watch a counter).
12813
12814The socket supports two operation modes :
12815 - interactive
12816 - non-interactive
12817
12818The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12819this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12820sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12821mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12822commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12823example :
12824
12825 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12826
12827The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12828entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12829for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12830sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12831"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12832after processing the last command of the same line.
12833
12834For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
12835"prompt" command :
12836
12837 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
12838 prompt
12839 > show info
12840 ...
12841 >
12842
12843Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
12844delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
12845that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
12846parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012847
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012848It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
12849on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
12850own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012851
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012852The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
12853If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
12854all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
12855it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
12856
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012857add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012858 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
12859 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
12860 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
12861 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012862
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012863add map <map> <key> <value>
12864 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
12865 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012866 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
12867 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
12868 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012869
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012870clear counters
12871 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
12872 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
12873 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
12874 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
12875 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12876
12877clear counters all
12878 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
12879 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
12880 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
12881
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012882clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012883 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
12884 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
12885 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012886
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012887clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012888 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
12889 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
12890 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012891
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012892clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
12893 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
12894
12895 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
12896 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
12897 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
12898 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
12899 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
12900 later after the session ends is usual enough.
12901
12902 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
12903
12904 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
12905 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
12906 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
12907 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
12908 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
12909 the ACLs :
12910
12911 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12912 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12913 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12914 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12915 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12916 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12917
12918 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012919 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12920 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012921
12922 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012923 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012924 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012925 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12926 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12927 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12928 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012929
12930 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12931
12932 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012933 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012934 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12935 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012936 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12937 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12938 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012939
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012940del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
12941 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012942 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
12943 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
12944 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
12945 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012946
12947del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010012948 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012949 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
12950 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
12951 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
12952 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010012953
12954disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012955 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
12956
12957 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
12958 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
12959 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
12960 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
12961 re-enabled using enable agent.
12962
12963 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
12964 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
12965 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
12966 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
12967 otherwise unchanged.
12968
12969 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
12970 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
12971 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
12972
12973 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12974 level "admin".
12975
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012976disable frontend <frontend>
12977 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
12978 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
12979 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
12980 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
12981 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
12982 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
12983 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
12984 on the stats page.
12985
12986 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12987 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12988
12989 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12990 level "admin".
12991
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012992disable server <backend>/<server>
12993 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
12994 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
12995 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
12996 during the maintenance.
12997
12998 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12999 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13000
13001 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013002 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013003
13004 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13005 level "admin".
13006
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013007enable agent <backend>/<server>
13008 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13009
13010 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13011 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13012
13013 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13014 level "admin".
13015
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013016enable frontend <frontend>
13017 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13018 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13019 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13020 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13021 which was disabled.
13022
13023 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13024 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13025
13026 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13027 level "admin".
13028
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013029enable server <backend>/<server>
13030 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13031 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13032
13033 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013034 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013035
13036 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13037 level "admin".
13038
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013039get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013040get acl <acl> <value>
13041 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13042 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13043 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13044 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13045 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013046
13047 The first two words are:
13048
13049 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13050 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13051 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13052
13053 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13054
13055 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13056
13057 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13058
13059 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13060 interpretation of the case.
13061
13062 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13063 useful with regular expressions.
13064
13065 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13066 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13067
13068 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13069 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13070 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13071
13072 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13073
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013074get weight <backend>/<server>
13075 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13076 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13077 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13078 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13079 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013080 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013081
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013082help
13083 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13084 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013085
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013086prompt
13087 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13088 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13089 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13090 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13091 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13092 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13093 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13094 command.
13095
13096quit
13097 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013098
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013099set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013100 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13101 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13102 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013103
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013104set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013105 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13106 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13107 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13108 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13109 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013110 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13111 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13112
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013113set maxconn global <maxconn>
13114 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13115 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13116 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13117 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13118 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13119 setting.
13120
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013121set rate-limit connections global <value>
13122 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13123 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13124 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13125 is passed in number of connections per second.
13126
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013127set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13128 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13129 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013130 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13131 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013132
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013133set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13134 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13135 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13136 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13137 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13138
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013139set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13140 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13141 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13142 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13143 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13144 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13145
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013146set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013147 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13148 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13149 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13150 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013151 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13152 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013153
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013154set timeout cli <delay>
13155 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13156 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13157 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13158
13159set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13160 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13161 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013162 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13163 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13164 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13165 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13166 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13167 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13168 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13169 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13170 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13171 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13172 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13173 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13174 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013175
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013176show errors [<iid>]
13177 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13178 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013179 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13180 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13181 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013182
13183 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13184 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13185 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13186 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13187 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13188 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13189 are reported too.
13190
13191 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13192 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13193 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13194 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13195 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13196 code.
13197
13198 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13199 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13200 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13201 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13202 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13203 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13204 line.
13205
13206 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013207 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13208 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013209 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13210 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13211
13212 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13213 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13214 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13215 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13216 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13217 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13218 00204+ minal\r\n
13219 00211 \r\n
13220
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013221 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013222 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13223 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13224 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13225 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13226 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13227 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013228
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013229show info
13230 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13231
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013232show map [<map>]
13233 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013234 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13235 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13236 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13237 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13238 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13239 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013240
13241show acl [<acl>]
13242 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013243 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13244 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13245 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13246 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13247 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013248
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013249show pools
13250 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13251 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13252 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13253 the pools.
13254
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013255show sess
13256 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013257 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13258 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13259
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013260show sess <id>
13261 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13262 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13263 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13264 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13265 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010013266 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
13267 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
13268 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013269
13270show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13271 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13272 possible to dump only selected items :
13273 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13274 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13275 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13276 for example:
13277 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13278 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13279 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13280
13281 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013282 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13283 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013284 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13285 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13286 Nbproc: 1
13287 Process_num: 1
13288 (...)
13289
13290 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13291 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13292 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13293 (...)
13294 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13295
13296 $
13297
13298 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13299 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13300 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13301 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013302 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013303
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013304show table
13305 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13306 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13307 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13308 entries currently in use.
13309
13310 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013311 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013312 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13313 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013314
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013315show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013316 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13317 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13318 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013319 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13320
13321 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13322 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13323 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13324 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13325 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13326
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013327 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13328 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13329 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13330 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13331 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13332 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13333
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013334
13335 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013336 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13337 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013338
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013339 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013340 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013341 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013342 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13343 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13344 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13345 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013346
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013347 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013348 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013349 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13350 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013351
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013352 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13353 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013354 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013355 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13356 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013357
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013358 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13359 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013360 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013361 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13362 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13363
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013364 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13365 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13366 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13367 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13368 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13369
13370 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13371 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13372 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013373 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13374 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013375 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13376 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013377
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013378shutdown frontend <frontend>
13379 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13380 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13381 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13382 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13383 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13384 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13385 once it is terminated.
13386
13387 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13388 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13389
13390 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13391 level "admin".
13392
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013393shutdown session <id>
13394 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13395 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13396 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13397 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13398 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13399 flag in the logs.
13400
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013401shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
13402 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13403 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13404 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13405 'K' flag in the logs.
13406
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013407/*
13408 * Local variables:
13409 * fill-column: 79
13410 * End:
13411 */